blob: adc6efa25bf913f814a208a43fefab0a39458944 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01007 2018/12/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-options
588 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-options
591 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100592 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100593 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100594 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100595 - 51degrees-data-file
596 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200597 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200598 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100599 - wurfl-data-file
600 - wurfl-information-list
601 - wurfl-information-list-separator
602 - wurfl-engine-mode
603 - wurfl-cache-size
604 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100623 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200624 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200625 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200626 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000627 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000628 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - tune.buffers.limit
630 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200631 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200632 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100633 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200634 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200635 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200636 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100637 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200638 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200639 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100640 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100642 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.session-timeout
644 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200645 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100646 - tune.maxaccept
647 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200649 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200650 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.rcvbuf.client
652 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100653 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200654 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100655 - tune.sndbuf.client
656 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100657 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200659 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200661 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200662 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100663 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100665 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
667 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
668 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100669 - tune.zlib.memlevel
670 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 * Debugging
673 - debug
674 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675
676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678------------------------------------
679
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680ca-base <dir>
681 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200682 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
683 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685chroot <jail dir>
686 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
687 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
688 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
689 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
690 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100691 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100692
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100693cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
694 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
695 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
696 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
697 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
698 set. These sets have the format
699
700 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
701
702 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
705 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
707 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100709 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
713 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
714 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
715 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100717 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
718 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
719 on the machine's word size.
720
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100721 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
723 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
724 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
725 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
726 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
727 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728
729 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
733 # first 4 CPUs
734
735 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
736 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
737 # word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
746 # and so on.
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
753 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
754 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
755
756 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
757 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
759
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
761 # and a thread range.
762 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
765
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200766crt-base <dir>
767 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
768 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
769 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771daemon
772 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
773 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100774 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
775 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777deviceatlas-json-file <path>
778 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780
781deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200783 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
784
785deviceatlas-separator <char>
786 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
787 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
788
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100789deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200790 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
791 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
792 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900794external-check
795 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
796 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
797 See "option external-check".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799gid <number>
800 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
801 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
802 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100803 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
804 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100806
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100807hard-stop-after <time>
808 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
809
810 Arguments :
811 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
812 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
813 SIGUSR1 signal.
814
815 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
816 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
817 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
818
819 Example:
820 global
821 hard-stop-after 30s
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823group <group name>
824 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
825 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200827log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100903 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200904
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100905 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
906 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
907 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
908
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100909 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
910 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
911 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
912 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913
914 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200915 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
916 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
917 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
918 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
919 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
920 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200921
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200922 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100924log-send-hostname [<string>]
925 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
926 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
927 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
928 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
929 the logs.
930
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000931log-tag <string>
932 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
933 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
934 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100935 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000936
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100937lua-load <file>
938 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
939 used multiple times.
940
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100941master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200942 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
943 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
944 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100945 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200946 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
947 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100948 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
949 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
950 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
951 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
952 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956nbproc <number>
957 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
958 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
959 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
960 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100961 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
962 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200963
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200964nbthread <number>
965 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
966 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
967 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100968 process. See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200969
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
973 starting the process. See also "daemon".
974
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100975presetenv <name> <value>
976 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
977 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
978 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
979 and "unsetenv".
980
981resetenv [<name> ...]
982 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
983 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
984 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
985 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
986 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
987 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
988 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
989 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
990
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100991stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200992 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
993 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
994 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
995 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
996 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
997 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100998 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100999 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1000 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1001 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1002 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001003
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001004server-state-base <directory>
1005 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001006 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1007 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001008
1009server-state-file <file>
1010 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1011 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1012 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1013 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1014 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1015 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1016 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1017 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001018 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1019 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001020
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001021setenv <name> <value>
1022 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1023 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1024 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1025 and "unsetenv".
1026
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001027ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1029 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001030 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 for all
1031 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
1032 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance
1033 a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). For
1034 TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites"
1035 keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1036
1037ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1039 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1040 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1041 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1042 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1043 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites", and can
1044 be for instance a string such as
1045 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
1046 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
1047 the "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
1048 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001049
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001050ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1052 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1053 keyword to see available options.
1054
1055 Example:
1056 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001057 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001058
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001059ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1061 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001062 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 with the server,
1063 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
1064 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration,
1065 please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the
1066 "server" keyword for more information.
1067
1068ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1069 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1070 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1071 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1072 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1073 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1074 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration for
1075 TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword.
1076 Please check the "server" keyword for more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001077
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001078ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1080 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1081 keyword to see available options.
1082
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001083ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1085 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1086 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001087 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001088 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001089 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1090 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1091 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1092 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001093 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1094 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1095 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1096
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001097ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1098 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1099 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1100 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1101
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001102stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1103 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1104 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1105 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001106 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001107 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001108
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001109 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1110 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1111 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001112
1113stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1114 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1115 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001116 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001117
1118stats maxconn <connections>
1119 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1120 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122uid <number>
1123 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1124 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1125 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1126 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1127
1128ulimit-n <number>
1129 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1130 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1131 option.
1132
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001133unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1134 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1135
1136 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1137 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1138 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1139 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1140 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1141 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1142 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1143 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1144 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1145 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1146
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001147unsetenv [<name> ...]
1148 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1149 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1150 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1151 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1152 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1153 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1154 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1155
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001156user <user name>
1157 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1158 See also "uid" and "group".
1159
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001160node <name>
1161 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1162
1163 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1164 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1165 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1166 traffic.
1167
1168description <text>
1169 Add a text that describes the instance.
1170
1171 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1172 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1173 "<" and ">" characters.
1174
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100117551degrees-data-file <file path>
1176 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001178
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001179 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001180 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1181
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000118251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001183 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1184 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1185 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1186
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001187 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001188 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1189
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200119051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001191 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1192 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1193
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001194 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1195 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1196
119751degrees-cache-size <number>
1198 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1199 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1200 By default, this cache is disabled.
1201
1202 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001203 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1204
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001205wurfl-data-file <file path>
1206 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1207 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1208
1209 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1210 with USE_WURFL=1.
1211
1212wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1213 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1214 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1215 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1216
1217 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1218
1219 Valid WURFL properties are:
1220 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1221
1222 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1223 device.
1224
1225 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1226 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1227
1228 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1229 particular web request.
1230
1231 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1232 used Libwurfl API version.
1233
1234 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1235 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1236 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1237
1238 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1239 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1240
1241 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1242 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1243
1244 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1245
1246 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1247
1248 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1249 with USE_WURFL=1.
1250
1251wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1252 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1253 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1254
1255 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1256 with USE_WURFL=1.
1257
1258wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1259 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1260 thus before the chroot.
1261
1262 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1263 with USE_WURFL=1.
1264
1265wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1266 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1267 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001268 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001269 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001270 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001271 mode is enabled by default.
1272
1273 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1274 with USE_WURFL=1.
1275
1276wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1277 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1278 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1279 - "0" : no cache is used.
1280 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1281 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1282 the highest performing option.
1283
1284 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1285 with USE_WURFL=1.
1286
1287wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1288 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1289 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1290
1291 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1292 with USE_WURFL=1.
1293
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012953.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001296-----------------------
1297
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001298busy-polling
1299 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1300 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1301 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1302 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1303 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1304 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1305 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1306 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1307 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1308 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1309 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1310 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1311 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1312 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1313 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1314 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1315 "poll" pollers.
1316
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001317max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1318 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1319 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1320 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1321 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1322 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1323 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1324 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1325 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1326
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001327maxconn <number>
1328 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1329 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1330 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001331 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1332 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1333 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1334 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001335 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1336 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1337 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1338 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1339 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001340
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001341maxconnrate <number>
1342 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1343 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1344 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1345 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1346 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1347 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1348 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1349 fairness.
1350
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001351maxcomprate <number>
1352 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001353 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001354 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1355 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1356 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001357 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001358 default value.
1359
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001360maxcompcpuusage <number>
1361 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1362 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1363 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1364 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1365 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1366 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1367 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1368 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1369
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001370maxpipes <number>
1371 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1372 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1373 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1374 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1375 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1376 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1377
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001378maxsessrate <number>
1379 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1380 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1381 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1382 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1383 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1384 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1385 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1386 fairness.
1387
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001388maxsslconn <number>
1389 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1390 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1391 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1392 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1393 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1394 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1395 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001396 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1397 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1398 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1399 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1400 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1401 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1402 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001403
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001404maxsslrate <number>
1405 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1406 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1407 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1408 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1409 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1410 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1411 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1412 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1413 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1414 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1415
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001416maxzlibmem <number>
1417 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1418 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1419 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001420 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1421 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1422 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1423
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001424noepoll
1425 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1426 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001427 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001428
1429nokqueue
1430 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1431 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1432 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1433
1434nopoll
1435 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1436 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001437 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001438 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001440nosplice
1441 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001442 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001443 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001444 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001445 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1446 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1447 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1448 "option splice-response".
1449
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001450nogetaddrinfo
1451 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1452 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1453
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001454noreuseport
1455 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1456 command line argument "-dR".
1457
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001458profiling.tasks { on | off }
1459 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1460 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1461 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1462 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1463 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1464 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1465 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1466 CLI.
1467
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001468spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001469 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1470 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1471 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1472 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1473 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1474 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001476ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001477 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001478 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001479 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1480 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1481 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1482 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1483 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1485 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001486 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1487 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1488 openssl configuration file uses:
1489 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1490
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001491ssl-mode-async
1492 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001493 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001494 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1495 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1496 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1497 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1498 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001499
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001500tune.buffers.limit <number>
1501 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1502 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1503 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1504 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1505 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001506 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001507 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1508 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1509 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1510 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1511 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1512 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1513 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1514 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1515 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1516
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001517tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1518 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1519 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1520 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1521 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1522
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001523tune.bufsize <number>
1524 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1525 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1526 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1527 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1528 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1529 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1530 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001531 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1532 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1533 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001534 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001535 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1536 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1537 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001538
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001539tune.chksize <number>
1540 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1541 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1542 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1543 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1544 checks whenever possible.
1545
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001546tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1547 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1548 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1549 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1550 this value. The default value is 1.
1551
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001552tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1553 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1554 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1555 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1556 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1557 change it.
1558
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001559tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1560 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001561 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1562 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001563 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1564 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1565 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1566 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1567 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1568
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001569tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1570 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1571 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1572 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1573 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1574 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1575 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1576 recommended not to change this value.
1577
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001578tune.http.cookielen <number>
1579 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1580 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1581 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1582 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1583 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1584 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1585 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1586 to change this value.
1587
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001588tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001589 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1590 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001591 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001592 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001593 configuration directives too.
1594 The default value is 1024.
1595
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001596tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1597 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1598 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1599 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1600 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1601 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1602 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001603 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1604 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1605 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001606
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001607tune.idletimer <timeout>
1608 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1609 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1610 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1611 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1612 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1613 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001614 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001615 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1616 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1617
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001618tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1619 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001620 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001621 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1622 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001623 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001624 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1625 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1626
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001627tune.lua.maxmem
1628 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1629 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1630 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1631 memory.
1632
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001633tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1634 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001635 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1636 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001637 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001638
1639tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1640 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1641 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1642 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1643 check servers.
1644
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001645tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1646 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1647 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1648 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001649 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001650
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001651tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001652 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1653 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1654 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1655 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1656 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1657 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1658 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1659 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1660 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1661 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001662
1663tune.maxpollevents <number>
1664 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1665 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1666 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1667 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1668 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1669
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001670tune.maxrewrite <number>
1671 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1672 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1673 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1674 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1675 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1676 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1677 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1678 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1679 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1680 bufsize.
1681
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001682tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1683 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1684 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1685 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1686 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1687 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1688 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1689 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1690 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1691 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1692 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1693 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1694 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1695 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1696 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1697 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1698 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1699 setting this parameter to 0.
1700
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001701tune.pipesize <number>
1702 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1703 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1704 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1705 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1706 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1707 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1708
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001709tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1710tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1711 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1712 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1713 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1714 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001715 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001716 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1717 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1718
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001719tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001720 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001721 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1722 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1723 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1724 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1725
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001726tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1727 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1728 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1729 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1730
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001731tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1732tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1733 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1734 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1735 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1736 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001737 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001738 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1739 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1740 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1741 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1742 notifying haproxy again.
1743
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001744tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001745 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1746 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1747 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001748 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001749 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001750 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001751 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1752 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1753 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001754 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1755 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001756
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001757tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001758 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001759 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1760 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1761 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1762 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1763 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1764
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001765tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1766 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001767 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001768 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1769 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1770 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1771 being used for too long.
1772
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001773tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1774 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1775 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1776 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1777 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1778 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1779 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1780 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1781 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1782 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1783 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001784 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001785 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001786
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001787tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1788 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1789 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1790 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1791 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1792 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1793 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1794 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001795 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1796 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001797
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001798tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1799 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1800 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1801 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1802 1000 entries.
1803
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001804tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1805 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1806 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1807 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1808
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001809tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001810tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001811tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1812tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1813tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001814 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1815 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1816 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1817 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1818 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1819 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1820 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1821 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001822
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001823 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1824 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1825 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1826 all available space is consumed.
1827 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1828 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1829 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001830
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001831tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1832 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001833 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001834 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001835 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001836 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1837
1838tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1839 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1840 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001841 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1842 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018443.3. Debugging
1845--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001846
1847debug
1848 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1849 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1850 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1851 system startup.
1852
1853quiet
1854 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1855 line argument "-q".
1856
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018583.4. Userlists
1859--------------
1860It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1861http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1862it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1863
1864userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001865 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001866 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1867
1868group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001869 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001870 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1871 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1872
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001873user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1874 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001875 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1876 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001877 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1878 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1879 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1880 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001881
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001882 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1883 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1884 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1885 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1886 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1887 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1888 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1889 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1890 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001891
1892 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001893 userlist L1
1894 group G1 users tiger,scott
1895 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001896
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001897 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1898 user scott insecure-password elgato
1899 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001900
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001901 userlist L2
1902 group G1
1903 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001904
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001905 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1906 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1907 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001908
1909 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001910
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001911
19123.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001913----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001914It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1915several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1916instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1917values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1918automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1919In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1920using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1921tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1922reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1923Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1924that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1925each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001926
1927peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001928 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001929 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1930
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001931bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1932 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
1933 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
1934
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001935disabled
1936 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1937 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1938 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1939
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001940default-bind [param*]
1941 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
1942
1943default-server [param*]
1944 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
1945
1946 Arguments:
1947 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1948 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1949 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1950 details.
1951
1952
1953 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
1954
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001955enable
1956 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1957
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001958peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001959 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1960 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1961 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1962 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1963 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1964 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1965
1966 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1967 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1968
1969 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1970 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1971 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1972 across all peers.
1973
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001974 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1975 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001976
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001977 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
1978 "server" keyword explanation below).
1979
1980server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
1981 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
1982 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
1983 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
1984 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
1985 of this "peers" section).
1986 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
1987
1988
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001989 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001990 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001991 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001992 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1993 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1994 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001995
1996 backend mybackend
1997 mode tcp
1998 balance roundrobin
1999 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2000 stick on src
2001
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002002 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2003 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002004
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002005 Example:
2006 peers mypeers
2007 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2008 default-server ssl verify none
2009 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2010 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002011
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090020123.6. Mailers
2013------------
2014It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2015If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2016in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2017
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002018mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002019 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2020 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2021
2022mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2023 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2024
2025 Example:
2026 mailers mymailers
2027 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2028 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2029
2030 backend mybackend
2031 mode tcp
2032 balance roundrobin
2033
2034 email-alert mailers mymailers
2035 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2036 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2037
2038 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2039 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2040
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002041timeout mail <time>
2042 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2043 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2044 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2045 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2046
2047 Example:
2048 mailers mymailers
2049 timeout mail 20s
2050 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002051
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020524. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002053----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002055Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002056 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002057 - frontend <name>
2058 - backend <name>
2059 - listen <name>
2060
2061A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2062its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2063section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002064section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002065
2066A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2067connections.
2068
2069A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2070to forward incoming connections.
2071
2072A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2073parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2074
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002075All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2076'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2077case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2078
2079Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2080logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2081proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2082However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2083name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2084
2085Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2086and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002087bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002088protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2089modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2090arbitrary criteria.
2091
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002092In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2093a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002094the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002095
2096 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2097 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2098 between responses and new requests.
2099
2100 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2101 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2102 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002103 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
2104 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002105
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002106 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2107 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2108 client-facing connection remains open.
2109
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002110 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2111 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002112
2113The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2114frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2115following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002116weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002117
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002118 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002119
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002120 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2121 ----+-----+-----+----
2122 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2123 ----+-----+-----+----
2124 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2125 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2126 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2127 ----+-----+-----+----
2128 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002130
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021324.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2133--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002135The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2136limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2137they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2138limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002139marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002140option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002141and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2142with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2143specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002144
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002145
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002146 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2147------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2148acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002149appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002150backlog X X X -
2151balance X - X X
2152bind - X X -
2153bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002154block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002155capture cookie - X X -
2156capture request header - X X -
2157capture response header - X X -
2158clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002159compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002160contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2161cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002162declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002163default-server X - X X
2164default_backend X X X -
2165description - X X X
2166disabled X X X X
2167dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002168email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002169email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002170email-alert mailers X X X X
2171email-alert myhostname X X X X
2172email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002173enabled X X X X
2174errorfile X X X X
2175errorloc X X X X
2176errorloc302 X X X X
2177-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2178errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002179force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002180filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002181fullconn X - X X
2182grace X X X X
2183hash-type X - X X
2184http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002185http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002186http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002187http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002188http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002189http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002190http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002191id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002192ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002193load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002194log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002195log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002196log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002197log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002198max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002199maxconn X X X -
2200mode X X X X
2201monitor fail - X X -
2202monitor-net X X X -
2203monitor-uri X X X -
2204option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2205option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2206option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2207option allbackups (*) X - X X
2208option checkcache (*) X - X X
2209option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2210option contstats (*) X X X -
2211option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2212option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002213option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002214-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2215option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002216option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002217option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002218option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002219option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002220option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002221option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002222option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002223option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002224option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002225option httpchk X - X X
2226option httpclose (*) X X X X
2227option httplog X X X X
2228option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002229option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002230option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002231option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002232option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2233option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2234option logasap (*) X X X -
2235option mysql-check X - X X
2236option nolinger (*) X X X X
2237option originalto X X X X
2238option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002239option pgsql-check X - X X
2240option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002241option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002242option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002243option smtpchk X - X X
2244option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2245option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2246option splice-request (*) X X X X
2247option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002248option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002249option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2250option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2251-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002252option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002253option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2254option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2255option tcpka X X X X
2256option tcplog X X X X
2257option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002258external-check command X - X X
2259external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002260persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2261rate-limit sessions X X X -
2262redirect - X X X
2263redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2264redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2265reqadd - X X X
2266reqallow - X X X
2267reqdel - X X X
2268reqdeny - X X X
2269reqiallow - X X X
2270reqidel - X X X
2271reqideny - X X X
2272reqipass - X X X
2273reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002274reqitarpit - X X X
2275reqpass - X X X
2276reqrep - X X X
2277-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002278reqtarpit - X X X
2279retries X - X X
2280rspadd - X X X
2281rspdel - X X X
2282rspdeny - X X X
2283rspidel - X X X
2284rspideny - X X X
2285rspirep - X X X
2286rsprep - X X X
2287server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002288server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002289server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002290source X - X X
2291srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002292stats admin - X X X
2293stats auth X X X X
2294stats enable X X X X
2295stats hide-version X X X X
2296stats http-request - X X X
2297stats realm X X X X
2298stats refresh X X X X
2299stats scope X X X X
2300stats show-desc X X X X
2301stats show-legends X X X X
2302stats show-node X X X X
2303stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002304-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2305stick match - - X X
2306stick on - - X X
2307stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002308stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002309stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002310tcp-check connect - - X X
2311tcp-check expect - - X X
2312tcp-check send - - X X
2313tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002314tcp-request connection - X X -
2315tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002316tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002317tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002318tcp-response content - - X X
2319tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002320timeout check X - X X
2321timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002322timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002323timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2324timeout connect X - X X
2325timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2326timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2327timeout http-request X X X X
2328timeout queue X - X X
2329timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002330timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002331timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2332timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002333timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002334transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002335unique-id-format X X X -
2336unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002337use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002338use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002339------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2340 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023434.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2344---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345
2346This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2347
2348
2349acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2350 Declare or complete an access list.
2351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2352 no | yes | yes | yes
2353 Example:
2354 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2355 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2356 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002358 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002359
2360
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002361appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2362 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2365 no | no | yes | yes
2366 Arguments :
2367 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2368 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2369
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002370 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002371 checked in each cookie value.
2372
2373 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2374 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2375 milliseconds.
2376
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002377 request-learn
2378 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2379 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2380 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2381 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2382 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2383 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2384
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002385 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2386 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2387 data following this prefix.
2388
2389 Example :
2390 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2391
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002392 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2393 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002394
2395 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2396 2 modes are currently supported :
2397 - path-parameters :
2398 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2399 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2400 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2401 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2402 - query-string :
2403 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2404 query string.
2405
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002406 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2407 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2408 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002409
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002410 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2411 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002412
2413
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002414backlog <conns>
2415 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2417 yes | yes | yes | no
2418 Arguments :
2419 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2420 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002421 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002422
2423 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2424 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2425 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2426 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2427 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2428 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2429 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2430 backlog parameter.
2431
2432 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2433 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2434 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2435
2436 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2437
2438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002439balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002440balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002441 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2443 yes | no | yes | yes
2444 Arguments :
2445 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2446 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2447 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2448 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2449
2450 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2451 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2452 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2453 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002454 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002455 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002456 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2457 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2458 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2459 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2460 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2461 it, so that you don't worry.
2462
2463 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2464 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2465 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2466 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2467 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2468 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2469 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2470 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002471
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002472 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2473 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2474 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2475 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2476 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2477 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2478 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2479 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2480
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002481 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002482 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002483 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2484 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002485 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002486 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2487 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2488 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2489 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2490 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002491 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2492 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2493 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2494 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2495 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2496 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002498 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2499 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2500 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2501 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2502 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2503 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2504 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2505 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002506 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002507 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002508 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2509 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2510 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002512 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2513 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2514 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2515 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2516 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2517 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2518 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2519 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2520 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2521 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2522 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2523 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002524
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002525 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002526 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2527 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2528 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2529 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2530 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2531 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2532 URIs start with a leading "/".
2533
2534 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2535 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2536 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2537 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002539 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002540 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2541
2542 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002543 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2544 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002545 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2546 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2547 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2548 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002549 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002550 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2551 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002552
2553 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2554 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2555 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2556 server will receive the request.
2557
2558 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2559 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2560 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2561 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2562 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002563 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2564 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2565 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002566
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002567 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2568 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2569 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2570 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2571 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002573 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002574 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2575 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2576 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2577
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002578 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2579 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2580 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2581
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002582 random
2583 random(<draws>)
2584 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002585 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2586 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2587 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2588 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002589 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2590 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2591 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2592 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2593 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2594 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2595 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2596 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2597 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2598 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2599 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2600 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2601 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2602 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2603 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2604 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2605 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2606 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2607 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2608 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002609
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002610 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002611 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002612 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2613 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2614 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2615 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2616 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2617 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002618 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002619 used instead.
2620
2621 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2622 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2623 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2624 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2625
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002626 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2627 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2628 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2629
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002630 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002632 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002633 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2634 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002635
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002636 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2637 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2638 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002639
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002640 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2641 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2642 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2643 NTLM relies on.
2644
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002645 Examples :
2646 balance roundrobin
2647 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002648 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002649 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2650 balance hdr(host)
2651 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002652
2653 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2654 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002656 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002657 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2658 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2659 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2660 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2661
2662 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2663 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2664 defaults to 16 kB.
2665
2666 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2667 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2668
2669 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2670 Round Robin.
2671
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002672 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002673 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2674 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2675 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2676
2677 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2678
2679 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002680 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002681 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2682 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2683 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002684
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002685 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002686
2687
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002688bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2689bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002690 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2692 no | yes | yes | no
2693 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002694 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2695 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2696 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2697 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002698 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002699 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2700 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2701 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2702 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2703 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2704 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2705 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002706 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2707 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2708 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2709 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2710 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2711 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2712 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002713 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2714 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2715 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002716 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2717 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2718 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2719 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002720 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2721 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2722 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002723
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002724 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2725 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002726 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2727 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2728 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002729 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2730 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2731 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2732 the range.
2733
2734 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2735 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2736 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2737 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2738 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2739 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2740 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002741 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002742 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002743
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002744 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002745 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002746 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2747 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2748 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2749 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2750 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2751 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2752
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002753 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2754 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2755 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2756 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002758 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2759 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2760 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2761 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2762 in a frontend.
2763
2764 Example :
2765 listen http_proxy
2766 bind :80,:443
2767 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002768 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002769
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002770 listen http_https_proxy
2771 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002772 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002773
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002774 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2775 bind ipv6@:80
2776 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2777 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2778
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002779 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002780 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002781
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002782 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2783 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2784 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2785 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2786 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2787
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002788 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002789 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002790
2791
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002792bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002793 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2795 yes | yes | yes | yes
2796 Arguments :
2797 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2798 may be used to override a default value.
2799
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002800 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002801 option may be combined with other numbers.
2802
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002803 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002804 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2805 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2806 missing from all processes.
2807
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002808 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002809 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002810 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2811 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2812 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2813 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2814 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002815 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002816
2817 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2818 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2819 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2820 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2821 and 'even' instances.
2822
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002823 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2824 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2825 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2826 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002827
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002828 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2829 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2830
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002831 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2832 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2833 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2834
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002835 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2836 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2837
2838 Example :
2839 listen app_ip1
2840 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002841 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002842
2843 listen app_ip2
2844 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002845 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002846
2847 listen management
2848 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002849 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002850
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002851 listen management
2852 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2853 bind-process 1-4
2854
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002855 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002856
2857
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002858block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002859 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2861 no | yes | yes | yes
2862
2863 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2864 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002865 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002866 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002867 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002868 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2869 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2870 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002871
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002872 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2873 "http-request deny" instead.
2874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875 Example:
2876 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2877 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2878 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002879 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2880 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2881 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002883 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2884 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2885 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886
2887capture cookie <name> len <length>
2888 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2890 no | yes | yes | no
2891 Arguments :
2892 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2893 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2894 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2895 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002896 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002897
2898 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2899 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2900 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2901 right if it exceeds <length>.
2902
2903 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2904 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2905 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2906 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2907
2908 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2909 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2910 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2911
2912 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2913 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2914 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002915 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2916 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2917 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002918
2919 Example:
2920 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2921
2922 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002923 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002924
2925
2926capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002927 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2929 no | yes | yes | no
2930 Arguments :
2931 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002932 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002933 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2934 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2935 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2936
2937 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2938 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2939 it exceeds <length>.
2940
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002941 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002942 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2943 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002944 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2945 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2946 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2947 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002948 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002949 environments to find where the request came from.
2950
2951 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2952 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2953 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2954 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002955
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002956 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2957 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2958 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2959 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2960 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002961
2962 Example:
2963 capture request header Host len 15
2964 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002965 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002967 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002968 about logging.
2969
2970
2971capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002972 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2974 no | yes | yes | no
2975 Arguments :
2976 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002977 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002978 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2979 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2980 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2981
2982 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2983 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2984 it exceeds <length>.
2985
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002986 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002987 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2988 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2989 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002990 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2991 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2992 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2993 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002994
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002995 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2996 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2997 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2998 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2999 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003000
3001 Example:
3002 capture response header Content-length len 9
3003 capture response header Location len 15
3004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003005 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003006 about logging.
3007
3008
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003009clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003010 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3012 yes | yes | yes | no
3013 Arguments :
3014 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3015 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3016 as explained at the top of this document.
3017
3018 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3019 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3020 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3021 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3022 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3023 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3024 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3025 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003026 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003027 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003028 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003029
3030 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3031 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3032 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3033 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3034 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3035 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3036
3037 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3038 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3039
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003040 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3041 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003042
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003043compression algo <algorithm> ...
3044compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003045compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003046 Enable HTTP compression.
3047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3048 yes | yes | yes | yes
3049 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003050 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3051 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3052 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3053
3054 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003055 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3056 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3057 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003058
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003059 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003060 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003061
3062 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3063 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3064 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3065 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3066 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003067 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003068
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003069 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3070 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3071 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3072 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3073 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3074 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3075 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003076 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003077
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003078 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003079 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003080 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3081 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3082 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3083 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3084 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003085
3086 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3087 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3088 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3089 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3090 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003091 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3092 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3093 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3094 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3095 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003096 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3097 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003098
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003099 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003100 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3101 "Accept-Encoding" header
3102 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003103 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003104 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3105 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3106 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3107 "multipart"
3108 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3109 header
3110 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3111 and later
3112 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3113 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003114 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003115
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003116 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003117
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003118 Examples :
3119 compression algo gzip
3120 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003121
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003122
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003123contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3126 yes | no | yes | yes
3127 Arguments :
3128 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3129 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3130 as explained at the top of this document.
3131
3132 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003133 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003134 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003135 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003136 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3137 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3138 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3139
3140 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3141 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3142 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3143 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3144 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3145 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3146
3147 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3148 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3149 instead.
3150
3151 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3152 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3153
3154
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003155cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003156 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3157 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003158 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003159 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3161 yes | no | yes | yes
3162 Arguments :
3163 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3164 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3165 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3166 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3167 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3168 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003169 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3171 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3172
3173 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3174 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3175 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3176 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3177 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3178 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003179 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3180 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003181 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003182 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3183 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003184
3185 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003186 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003187
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003188 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003189 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3190 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003191 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003192 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3193 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3194 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3195 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3196 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3197 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3198 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003199
3200 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3201 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3202 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3203 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3204 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3205 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3206 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3207 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3208 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003209 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003210 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3211 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3212 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003213
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003214 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3215 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3216 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003217 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3218 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3219 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3220 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003221 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3222 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3223 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003224
3225 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3226 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3227 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3228 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3229 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3230 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3231 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3232 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3233 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3234
3235 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3236 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3237 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3238 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3239 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3240 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3241 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3242 persistence cookie in the cache.
3243 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3244
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003245 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3246 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3247 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3248 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3249 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003250 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003251 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3252 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3253 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3254 they logout.
3255
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003256 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3257 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3258 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3259 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3260
3261 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3262 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3263 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3264 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3265 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3266 this attribute.
3267
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003268 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003269 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003270 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3271 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3272 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3273 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3274 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3275 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003276
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003277 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3278 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3279 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3280 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3281 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3282 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3283 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3284 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003285 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003286 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3287 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3288 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3289 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3290 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3291 the site.
3292
3293 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3294 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3295 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3296 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3297 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3298 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3299 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3300 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3301 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3302 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3303 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3304 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3305 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003306 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003307 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3308 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3309
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003310 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3311 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3312 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3313 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3314 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3315 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3316
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003317 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3318 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3319 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3320 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003322 Examples :
3323 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3324 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3325 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003326 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003327
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003328 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003329
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003330
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003331declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3332 Declares a capture slot.
3333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3334 no | yes | yes | no
3335 Arguments:
3336 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3337
3338 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3339 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3340 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3341 for use in the response.
3342
3343 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003344 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003345 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3346
3347
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003348default-server [param*]
3349 Change default options for a server in a backend
3350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3351 yes | no | yes | yes
3352 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003353 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3354 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3355 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3356 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003357
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003358 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003359 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3360
3361 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003362
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364default_backend <backend>
3365 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3367 yes | yes | yes | no
3368 Arguments :
3369 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3370
3371 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3372 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3373 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3374 will catch all undetermined requests.
3375
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003376 Example :
3377
3378 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3379 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3380 default_backend dynamic
3381
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003382 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003383
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003384
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003385description <string>
3386 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3388 no | yes | yes | yes
3389 Arguments : string
3390
3391 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3392 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3393 it describes.
3394 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3395
3396
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003397disabled
3398 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3400 yes | yes | yes | yes
3401 Arguments : none
3402
3403 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3404 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3405 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3406 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3407 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3408 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3409 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3410
3411 See also : "enabled"
3412
3413
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003414dispatch <address>:<port>
3415 Set a default server address
3416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3417 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003418 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003419
3420 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3421 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3422 during start-up.
3423
3424 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3425 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3426 possible with normal servers.
3427
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003428 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003429 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3430 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3431 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3432 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3433
3434 See also : "server"
3435
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003436
3437dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3438 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3440 yes | no | yes | yes
3441 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3442
3443 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003444 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003445 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3446 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003447 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003448 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003449
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003450enabled
3451 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3453 yes | yes | yes | yes
3454 Arguments : none
3455
3456 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3457 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3458
3459 See also : "disabled"
3460
3461
3462errorfile <code> <file>
3463 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3465 yes | yes | yes | yes
3466 Arguments :
3467 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003468 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3469 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003470
3471 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003472 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003473 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003474 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3475 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476
3477 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3478 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3479 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3480
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003481 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3482
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003483 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3484 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3485 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3486 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3487
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003488 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3489 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003490 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003491 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3492 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3493 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3494
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003495 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3496 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3497 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003498 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003499 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3500
3501 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3502
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003503 Example :
3504 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003505 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003506 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3507 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3508
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003509
3510errorloc <code> <url>
3511errorloc302 <code> <url>
3512 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3514 yes | yes | yes | yes
3515 Arguments :
3516 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003517 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3518 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003519
3520 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3521 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3522 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3523 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003524 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003525
3526 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3527 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3528 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3529
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003530 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3531
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003532 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3533 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3534 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3535 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003536 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003537 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3538 request.
3539
3540 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3541
3542
3543errorloc303 <code> <url>
3544 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3546 yes | yes | yes | yes
3547 Arguments :
3548 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003549 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3550 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003551
3552 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3553 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3554 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3555 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003556 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003557
3558 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3559 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3560 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3561
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003562 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3563
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003564 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3565 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3566 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3567 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003568 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003569
3570 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3571
3572
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003573email-alert from <emailaddr>
3574 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003575 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3577 yes | yes | yes | yes
3578
3579 Arguments :
3580
3581 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3582
3583 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3584 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3585
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003586 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003587 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3588 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003589
3590
3591email-alert level <level>
3592 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3593 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3594 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3595 yes | yes | yes | yes
3596
3597 Arguments :
3598
3599 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3600 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3601 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3602
3603 By default level is alert
3604
3605 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3606 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3607 for the proxy.
3608
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003609 Alerts are sent when :
3610
3611 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3612 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3613 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3614 is notice or lower
3615 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3616 and a health check status update occurs
3617
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003618 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3619 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003620 section 3.6 about mailers.
3621
3622
3623email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3624 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3625 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3626 yes | yes | yes | yes
3627
3628 Arguments :
3629
3630 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3631
3632 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3633 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3634
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003635 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3636 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003637
3638
3639email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3640 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3641 mailers.
3642 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3643 yes | yes | yes | yes
3644
3645 Arguments :
3646
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003647 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003648
3649 By default the systems hostname is used.
3650
3651 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3652 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3653 for the proxy.
3654
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003655 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3656 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003657
3658
3659email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003660 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003661 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3662 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3663 yes | yes | yes | yes
3664
3665 Arguments :
3666
3667 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3668
3669 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3670 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3671
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003672 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003673 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3674
3675
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003676force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3677 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3678 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003679 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003680
3681 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3682 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3683 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3684 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3685 marked down for maintenance operations.
3686
3687 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3688 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3689 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3690 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3691 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3692 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3693 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3694 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3695 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3696
3697 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3698 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3699 is used.
3700
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003701 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003702 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003703
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003704
3705filter <name> [param*]
3706 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3708 no | yes | yes | yes
3709 Arguments :
3710 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3711 referenced in section 9.
3712
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003713 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003714 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003715 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3716 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003717
3718 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3719 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3720
3721 Example:
3722 listen
3723 bind *:80
3724
3725 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3726 filter compression
3727 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3728
3729 compression algo gzip
3730 compression offload
3731
3732 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3733
3734 See also : section 9.
3735
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003736
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003737fullconn <conns>
3738 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3740 yes | no | yes | yes
3741 Arguments :
3742 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3743 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3744
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003745 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003746 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003747 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003748 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3749 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3750 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3751 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3752 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003753 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003754
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003755 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3756 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003757 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3758 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3759 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003760
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003761 Example :
3762 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3763 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3764 # connections.
3765 backend dynamic
3766 fullconn 10000
3767 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3768 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3769
3770 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3771
3772
3773grace <time>
3774 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003776 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003777 Arguments :
3778 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3779 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3780 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3781
3782 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3783 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003784 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003785 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3786
3787 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3788 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3789 simplify it.
3790
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003791
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003792hash-balance-factor <factor>
3793 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3795 yes | no | no | yes
3796 Arguments :
3797 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3798 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3799 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3800
3801 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3802 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3803 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3804 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3805 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3806 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3807 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3808
3809 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3810 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3811 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3812 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3813 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3814
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003815 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3816 consistent hashing mechanism.
3817
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003818 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3819
3820
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003821hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003822 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3824 yes | no | yes | yes
3825 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003826 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3827 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003828
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003829 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3830 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3831 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3832 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3833 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3834 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3835 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3836 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3837 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3838 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003839
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003840 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3841 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3842 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3843 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3844 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3845 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3846 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3847 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3848 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3849 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3850 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3851 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3852 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003853 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3854 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003855
3856 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3857
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003858 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003859 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3860 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3861 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003862 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3863 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3864 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003865
3866 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3867 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003868 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3869 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3870 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3871 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3872
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003873 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3874 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3875 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3876 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3877 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3878 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3879 parameter.
3880
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003881 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3882 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3883 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3884 used on strings.
3885
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003886 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3887
3888 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3889 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3890 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3891 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3892 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3893 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3894 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3895 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3896 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3897 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3898 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3899 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003900
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003901 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3902 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3903 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003904
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003905 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003906
3907
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003908http-check disable-on-404
3909 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003911 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003912 Arguments : none
3913
3914 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3915 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3916 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3917 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3918 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3919 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3920 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3921 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003922 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3923 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3924 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3925
3926 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3927
3928
3929http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003930 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003932 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003933 Arguments :
3934 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3935 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003936 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003937 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3938 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3939 details on the supported keywords.
3940
3941 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3942 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3943 with the usual backslash ('\').
3944
3945 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3946 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3947 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3948 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3949 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3950
3951 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003952 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003953 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3954 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3955 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3956
3957 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003958 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003959 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3960 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3961 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3962 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3963
3964 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003965 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003966 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3967 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3968 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3969 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3970 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003971 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003972 trace).
3973
3974 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003975 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003976 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3977 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3978 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3979 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3980 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003981 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003982
3983 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3984 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3985 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3986 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3987 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3988 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3989 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3990 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3991
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003992 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3993 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3994 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3995
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003996 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3997 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3998
3999 Examples :
4000 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004001 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004002
4003 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004004 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004005
4006 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004007 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004008
4009 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004010 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004011
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004012 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004013
4014
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004015http-check send-state
4016 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4018 yes | no | yes | yes
4019 Arguments : none
4020
4021 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4022 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4023 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4024 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4025 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4026
4027 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4028 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4029 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4030 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4031 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004032 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4033 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4034 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4035
4036 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4037 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4038 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4039
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004040 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4041 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4042 checked in multiple backends.
4043
4044 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4045 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4046
4047 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4048 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4049 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4050 one fails.
4051
4052 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4053 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4054 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4055
4056 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4057 server's queue.
4058
4059 Example of a header received by the application server :
4060 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4061 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4062
4063 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004065
4066http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004067 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4068
4069 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4070 no | yes | yes | yes
4071
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004072 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4073 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4074 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4075 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4076 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004077
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004078 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4079 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004081 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004083 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4084 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4085 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4086 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004088 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4089 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4090 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4091 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004092
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004093 Example:
4094 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4095 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4096 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004097
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004098 http-request allow if nagios
4099 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4100 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4101 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004103 Example:
4104 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4105 acl add path /addacl
4106 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004108 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004110 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4111 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004113 Example:
4114 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4115 acl setmap path /setmap
4116 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004118 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004120 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4121 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004123 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4124 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004126http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004127
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004128 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4129 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4130 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4131 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4132 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4133 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4134 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4135 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004136
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004137http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004139 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4140 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4141 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4142 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4143 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4144 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4145 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4146 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004148http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004149
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004150 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4151 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004152
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004154http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004156 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4157 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4158 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4159 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4160 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004162 Example:
4163 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4164 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004165
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004166http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004168 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004170http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4171 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004173 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4174 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4175 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4176 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4177 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4178 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4179 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4180 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4181 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004182
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004183 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4184 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4185 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4186 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4187 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4188 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004190http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004192 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4193 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4194 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4195 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4196 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4197 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004199http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004200
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004201 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004203http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004205 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4206 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4207 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4208 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4209 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4210 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004212http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004214 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4215 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4216 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4217 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4218 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004219
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004220http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4221
4222 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4223 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4224 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4225 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004226 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4227 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004228
4229 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4230
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004231http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004233 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4234 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4235 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4236 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4237 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004238
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004239http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004241 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4242 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4243 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4244 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004246http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4247 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004249 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4250 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4251 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4252 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4253 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4254 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4255 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4256 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004257
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004258 Example:
4259 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004261 # applied to:
4262 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004264 # outputs:
4265 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004267 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004269http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4270 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004272 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4273 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4274 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4275 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004277 Example:
4278 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004280 # applied to:
4281 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004282
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004283 # outputs:
4284 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004286http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4287http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4290 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4291 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004293http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004295 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4296 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4297 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004301 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4302 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4303 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4304 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4305 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004307 Arguments:
4308 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4309 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 Example:
4312 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4313 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004315 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4316 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004318http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004320 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4321 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4322 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324 Arguments:
4325 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4326 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004328 Example:
4329 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4330 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004331
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004332 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4333 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4334 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004336http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4339 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4340 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4341 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4342 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004343
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004344 Example:
4345 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4346 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4347 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4348 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4349 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4350 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4351 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4352 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4353 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004355http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4358 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4359 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4360 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4361 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004363http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004366 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4367 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4368 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4369 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4370 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4371 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4372 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4373 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4374 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004376http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4379 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4380 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4381 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4382 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4383 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4384 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004388 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4389 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4390 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004391
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004392http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004394 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4395 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4396 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4397 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4398 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4399 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4400 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4401 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004403http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004405 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4406 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4407 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4408 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4409 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4410 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004411
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004412 Example :
4413 # prepend the host name before the path
4414 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004416http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004418 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4419 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4420 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4421 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4422 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004424http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004426 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4427 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4428 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4429 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4430 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4431 values have higher priority.
4432 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4433 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4434 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4435 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4436 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004437
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004438http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004440 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4441 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4442 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4443 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4444 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4445 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4446 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004447
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004448 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004449
4450 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004451 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4452 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004454http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4455 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4456 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4457 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4458 privacy.
4459
4460 Arguments :
4461 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4462 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004463
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004464 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004465 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4466 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4467
4468 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4469 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4470
4471http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4472
4473 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4474 expression.
4475
4476 Arguments:
4477 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4478 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004479
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004480 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004481 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4482 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4483
4484 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4485 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4486 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4487
4488http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4489
4490 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4491 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4492 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4493 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4494 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4495 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4496 information from the request.
4497
4498 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4499
4500http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4501
4502 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4503 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4504 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4505 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4506 path and the query string.
4507 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4508
4509http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4510
4511 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4512 inline.
4513
4514 Arguments:
4515 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4516 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4517 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4518 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4519 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4520 (request and response)
4521 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4522 processing
4523 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4524 processing
4525 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4526 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4527 and '_'.
4528
4529 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4530 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004531
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004532 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004533 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004535http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4536 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004538 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4539 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4540 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4541 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4542 agent name must be used.
4543
4544 Arguments:
4545 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4546
4547 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4548 configuration.
4549
4550http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4551
4552 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4553 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4554 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4555 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4556 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4557 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4558 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4559 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4560 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4561 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4562 action.
4563 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4564 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4565 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4566 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4567 you fully understand how it works.
4568
4569http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4570
4571 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4572 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4573 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4574 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4575 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4576 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4577 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4578 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4579 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4580 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4581 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4582 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4583 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4584
4585http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4586http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4587http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4588
4589 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4590 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4591 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4592 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4593 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4594 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4595 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4596 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4597 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4598 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4599 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4600 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4601
4602 Arguments :
4603 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4604 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4605 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4606 select which table entry to update the counters.
4607
4608 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4609 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4610 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4611 that table until the session ends.
4612
4613 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4614 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4615 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4616 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4617 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4618 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4619 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4620 useful information.
4621
4622 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4623 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4624 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4625 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4626 checks that make use of it.
4627
4628http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4629
4630 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004631
4632 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004633 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004635http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004637 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4638 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4639 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004640
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004641
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004642http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004643 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4644
4645 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4646 no | yes | yes | yes
4647
4648 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4649 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4650 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4651 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4652 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4653 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4654
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004655 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4656 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004657
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004658 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004659
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004660 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4661 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4662 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4663 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004664
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004665 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4666 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4667 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4668 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004669
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004670 Example:
4671 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004672
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004673 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004674
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004675 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4676 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004677
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004678 Example:
4679 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004680
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004681 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004683 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4684 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004685
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004686 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4687 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004688
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004689http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004690
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004691 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4692 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4693 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4694 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4695 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4696 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4697 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4698 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004699
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004700http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004701
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004702 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4703 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4704 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4705 example, or to pass some internal information.
4706 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4707 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4708 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004709
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004710http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004711
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004712 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4713 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004714
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004715http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004716
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004717 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004718
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004719http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004720
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004721 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4722 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4723 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4724 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4725 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4726 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4727 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004728
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004729 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4730 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4731 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4732 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4733 keyword.
4734 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4735 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004736
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004737http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004738
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004739 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4740 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4741 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4742 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4743 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4744 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004745
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004746http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004747
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004748 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004749
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004750http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004751
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004752 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4753 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4754 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4755 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4756 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4757 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004759http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004760
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004761 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4762 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004763
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004764http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004765
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004766 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4767 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4768 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4769 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4770 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4771 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004772
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004773http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4774 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004775
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004776 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4777 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4778 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4779 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4780 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4781 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4782 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4783 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004784
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004785 Example:
4786 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004787
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004788 # applied to:
4789 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004791 # outputs:
4792 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004793
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004794 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004795
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004796http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4797 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004798
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004799 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4800 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4801 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4802 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004803
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004804 Example:
4805 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004806
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004807 # applied to:
4808 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004809
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004810 # outputs:
4811 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004812
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004813http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4814http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004815
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004816 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4817 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4818 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004819
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004820http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004821
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004822 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4823 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4824 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004825
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004826http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004827
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004828 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4829 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4830 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4831 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4832 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004834 Arguments:
4835 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004836
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004837 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4838 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004840http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004841
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004842 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4843 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4844 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004846http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4847
4848 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4849 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4850 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4851 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4852 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4853
4854http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4855
4856 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4857 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4858 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4859 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4860 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4861 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4862 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4863 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4864 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4865
4866http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4867
4868 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4869 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4870 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4871 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4872 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4873 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4874 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4875
4876http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4877
4878 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4879 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4880 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4881 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4882 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4883 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4884 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4885 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4886
4887http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4888 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4889
4890 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4891 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4892 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4893 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004894
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004895 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004896 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4897 http-response set-status 431
4898 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4899 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004900
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004901http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004903 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4904 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4905 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4906 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4907 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4908 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4909 based on some information from the request.
4910
4911 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4912
4913http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4914
4915 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4916 inline.
4917
4918 Arguments:
4919 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4920 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4921 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4922 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4923 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4924 (request and response)
4925 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4926 processing
4927 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4928 processing
4929 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4930 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4931 and '_'.
4932
4933 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4934 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004935
4936 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004937 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004939http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004941 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4942 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4943 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4944 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4945 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4946 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4947 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4948 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4949 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4950 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4951 action.
4952 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4953 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4954 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4955 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4956 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004958http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4959http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4960http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004962 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
4963 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4964 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
4965 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
4966 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
4967 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4968
4969http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4970
4971 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
4972 about <var-name>.
4973
4974 Example:
4975 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4976
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004977
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004978http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4979 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4980
4981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4982 yes | no | yes | yes
4983
4984 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004985 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
4986 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
4987 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004988
4989 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4990
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004991 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
4992 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
4993 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
4994 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
4995 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
4996 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
4997 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
4998 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
4999 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5000 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005001
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005002 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5003 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5004 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5005 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5006 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5007 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5008 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5009 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005010
5011 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5012 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5013 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5014 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5015 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5016 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5017 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5018 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5019 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5020 downsides of rare connection failures.
5021
5022 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5023 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5024 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5025 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5026 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5027 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005028 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005029 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5030 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5031 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5032 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5033 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5034
5035 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005036 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5037 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5038 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005039
5040 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005041 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005042
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005043 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5044 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005045
5046 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5047 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5048 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5049
5050 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5051 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5052 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5053
5054 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5055
5056
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005057http-send-name-header [<header>]
5058 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5059
5060 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5061 yes | no | yes | yes
5062
5063 Arguments :
5064
5065 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5066
5067 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005068 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005069 is added with the header string proved.
5070
5071 See also : "server"
5072
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005073id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005074 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5076 no | yes | yes | yes
5077 Arguments : none
5078
5079 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5080 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5081 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005082
5083
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005084ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5085 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5086 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005087 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005088
5089 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5090 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5091 and running).
5092
5093 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5094 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5095 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005096 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005097 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5098
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005099 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5100 "unless" condition is met.
5101
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005102 Example:
5103 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5104 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5105 ignore-persist if url_static
5106
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005107 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5108
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005109load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5110 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5111 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5112 yes | no | yes | yes
5113
5114 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5115 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5116 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005117 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005118 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5119 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5120 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5121 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5122
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005123 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005124 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005125 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005126
5127 Arguments:
5128 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5129 named "server-state-file".
5130
5131 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5132 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5133 name is used as a file name.
5134
5135 none don't load any stat for this backend
5136
5137 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005138 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5139 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5140 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005141 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005142 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005143
5144 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5145 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5146
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005147 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005148
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005149 global
5150 stats socket /tmp/socket
5151 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005152
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005153 defaults
5154 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005155
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005156 backend bk
5157 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5158 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005159
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005160
5161 Then one can run :
5162
5163 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5164
5165 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5166
5167 1
5168 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5169 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5170 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5171
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005172 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005173
5174 global
5175 stats socket /tmp/socket
5176 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5177
5178 defaults
5179 load-server-state-from-file local
5180
5181 backend bk
5182 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5183 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5184
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005185
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005186 Then one can run :
5187
5188 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5189
5190 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5191
5192 1
5193 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5194 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5195 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5196
5197 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5198 "show servers state"
5199
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005200
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005201log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005202log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005203no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005204 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5206 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005207
5208 Prefix :
5209 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5210 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5211 prefix does not allow arguments.
5212
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005213 Arguments :
5214 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5215 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5216 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5217 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5218 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5219 parameter.
5220
5221 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5222 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5223
5224 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5225 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5226 standard syslog port).
5227
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005228 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5229 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5230 standard syslog port).
5231
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005232 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5233 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5234 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005235 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005236
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005237 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5238 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5239 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5240 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5241 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5242 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5243 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5244 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5245 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5246 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5247 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5248 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5249 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5250 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5251 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5252 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005253 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5254 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005255
5256 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5257 and "fd@2", see above.
5258
5259 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5260 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005261
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005262 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5263 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5264 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5265 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5266 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5267 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5268 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5269 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5270 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5271 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005272 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005273
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005274 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5275 one of the following :
5276
5277 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5278 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5279
5280 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5281 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5282
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005283 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5284 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5285 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5286 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5287 systemd logger consumes.
5288
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005289 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5290 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5291 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5292 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5293
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005294 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5295
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005296 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5297 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5298 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5299
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005300 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5301 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5302 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5303 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005304
5305 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5306 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5307 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005308 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5309 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5310 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5311 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5312 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005313
5314 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5315
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005316 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5317 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5318 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005319
5320 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5321 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5322 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5323 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5324
5325 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5326 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005327
5328 Example :
5329 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005330 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5331 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5332 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005333 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5334 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005335 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005336
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005337
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005338log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005339 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5340 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5341 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005342
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005343 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5344 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5345 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5346 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5347 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005348
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005349 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5350 "option httplog" directives.
5351
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005352log-format-sd <string>
5353 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5354 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5355 yes | yes | yes | no
5356
5357 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5358 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5359 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5360 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5361 which covers the log format string in depth.
5362
5363 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5364 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5365
5366 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5367 log format to "rfc5424".
5368
5369 Example :
5370 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5371
5372
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005373log-tag <string>
5374 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5375 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5376 yes | yes | yes | yes
5377
5378 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5379 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5380 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5381 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5382 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5383 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5384 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5385 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5386 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005387
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005388max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5389 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5390 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5391 yes | no | yes | yes
5392
5393 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5394 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5395 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5396 servers.
5397
5398 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5399 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5400 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5401 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5402 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005403 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005404 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5405 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5406 picking a different server.
5407
5408 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5409 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5410 even if they have to be queued.
5411
5412 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5413 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5414
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005415max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5416 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5417 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5418 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005419
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005420maxconn <conns>
5421 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5423 yes | yes | yes | no
5424 Arguments :
5425 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5426 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5427 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5428 closes.
5429
5430 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5431 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5432 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5433 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005434 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5435 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5436 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5437 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005438
5439 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5440 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5441 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5442
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005443 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5444
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005445 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5446
5447
5448mode { tcp|http|health }
5449 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5451 yes | yes | yes | yes
5452 Arguments :
5453 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5454 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5455 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5456 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5457
5458 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5459 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5460 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5461 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5462 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5463
5464 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005465 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5466 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5467 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5468 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5469 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5470 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5471 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005472
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005473 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5474 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5475 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005476
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005477 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005478 defaults http_instances
5479 mode http
5480
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005481 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005482
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005483
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005484monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005485 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5487 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005488 Arguments :
5489 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5490 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005491 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005492 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5493 backend and its backup.
5494
5495 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5496 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5497 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5498 servers in a list of backends.
5499
5500 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5501 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5502 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5503 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5504 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5505 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5506 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005507 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5508 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005509
5510 Example:
5511 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005512 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005513 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5514 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5515 monitor-uri /site_alive
5516 monitor fail if site_dead
5517
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005518 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005519
5520
5521monitor-net <source>
5522 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5524 yes | yes | yes | no
5525 Arguments :
5526 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5527 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5528 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5529 followed by a mask.
5530
5531 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5532 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005533 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005534 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5535
5536 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5537 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5538 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5539 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005540 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5541 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5542 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005543
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005544 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5545 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5546 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5547 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5548 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5549 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005550
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005551 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5552 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005553
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005554 Example :
5555 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5556 frontend www
5557 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5558
5559 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5560
5561
5562monitor-uri <uri>
5563 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5565 yes | yes | yes | no
5566 Arguments :
5567 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5568 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5569
5570 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5571 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5572 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5573 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5574 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5575 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5576 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5577 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5578
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005579 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5580 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5581 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5582 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5583 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5584 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5585 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5586 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005587
5588 Example :
5589 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5590 frontend www
5591 mode http
5592 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5593
5594 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5595
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005596
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005597option abortonclose
5598no option abortonclose
5599 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5601 yes | no | yes | yes
5602 Arguments : none
5603
5604 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5605 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5606 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5607 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005608 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005609 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5610 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5611 encountered while delivering the response.
5612
5613 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5614 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5615 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5616 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5617 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5618 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005619 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005620 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005621 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005622 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5623 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5624 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5625
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005626 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5627 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005628 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5629 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5630 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5631 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5632 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5633 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005634 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005635
5636 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5637 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5638
5639 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5640
5641
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005642option accept-invalid-http-request
5643no option accept-invalid-http-request
5644 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5646 yes | yes | yes | no
5647 Arguments : none
5648
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005649 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005650 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005651 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005652 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5653 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5654 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5655 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5656 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005657 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5658 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5659 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5660 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005661 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005662 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005663 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5664 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5665 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005666
5667 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5668 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5669 been confirmed.
5670
5671 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5672 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005673 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5674 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005675 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5676
5677 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5678 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5679
5680 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5681 stats socket.
5682
5683
5684option accept-invalid-http-response
5685no option accept-invalid-http-response
5686 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5688 yes | no | yes | yes
5689 Arguments : none
5690
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005691 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005692 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005693 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005694 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5695 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5696 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5697 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5698 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005699 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5700 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5701 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005702
5703 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5704 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5705 been confirmed.
5706
5707 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5708 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5709 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5710 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5711
5712 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5713 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5714
5715 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5716 stats socket.
5717
5718
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005719option allbackups
5720no option allbackups
5721 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5723 yes | no | yes | yes
5724 Arguments : none
5725
5726 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5727 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5728 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5729 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5730 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5731 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5732 order between the backup servers anymore.
5733
5734 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5735 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5736
5737 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5738 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5739
5740
5741option checkcache
5742no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005743 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5745 yes | no | yes | yes
5746 Arguments : none
5747
5748 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5749 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005750 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005751 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5752 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005753 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005754
5755 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005756 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005757 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005758 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5759 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005760 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005761 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005762 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5763 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005764 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005765 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5766 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005767 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005768 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5769 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5770 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5771 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5772 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5773 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5774 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5775 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5776 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5777
5778 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005779 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005780 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005781 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005782 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5783
5784 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5785 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005786 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005787 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005788
5789 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5790 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5791
5792
5793option clitcpka
5794no option clitcpka
5795 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5797 yes | yes | yes | no
5798 Arguments : none
5799
5800 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5801 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005802 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005803 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5804
5805 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5806 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5807 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5808 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5809
5810 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5811 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5812 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5813 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5814 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5815
5816 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5817
5818 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5819 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5820 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5821
5822 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5823 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5824
5825 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5826
5827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005828option contstats
5829 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5831 yes | yes | yes | no
5832 Arguments : none
5833
5834 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5835 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5836 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5837 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005838 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5839 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5840 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5841 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5842 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005843
5844
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005845option dontlog-normal
5846no option dontlog-normal
5847 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5849 yes | yes | yes | no
5850 Arguments : none
5851
5852 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5853 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5854 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5855 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5856 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5857 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5858 logged.
5859
5860 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5861 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5862 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5863
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005864 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005865 logging.
5866
5867
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005868option dontlognull
5869no option dontlognull
5870 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5872 yes | yes | yes | no
5873 Arguments : none
5874
5875 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5876 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5877 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5878 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5879 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5880 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005881 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5882 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5883 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005884
5885 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005886 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005887 would not be logged.
5888
5889 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5890 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5891
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005892 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5893 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005894
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005895
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005896option forceclose (deprecated)
5897no option forceclose (deprecated)
5898 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005899
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005900 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005901
5902
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005903option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005904 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5906 yes | yes | yes | yes
5907 Arguments :
5908 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5909 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005910 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005911 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005912
5913 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5914 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5915 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5916 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5917 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5918 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5919 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005920 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5921 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5922 possible that the client has already brought one.
5923
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005924 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005925 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005926 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005927 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005928 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005929 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005930
5931 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5932 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5933 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5934 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5935 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5936 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5937 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5938
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005939 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5940 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5941 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5942 are under the control of the end-user.
5943
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005944 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005945 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5946 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005947 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5948 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5949 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005950
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005951 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005952 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5953 frontend www
5954 mode http
5955 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5956
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005957 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5958 backend www
5959 mode http
5960 option forwardfor header X-Client
5961
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005962 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005963 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005964
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005965
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005966option http-buffer-request
5967no option http-buffer-request
5968 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5970 yes | yes | yes | yes
5971 Arguments : none
5972
5973 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5974 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5975 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5976 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5977 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5978 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5979 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5980 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005981 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005982 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5983 default.
5984
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005985 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005986
5987
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005988option http-ignore-probes
5989no option http-ignore-probes
5990 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5992 yes | yes | yes | no
5993 Arguments : none
5994
5995 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5996 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5997 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5998 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5999 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6000 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6001 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6002 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6003 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006004 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6005 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006006 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6007
6008 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6009 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6010 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6011 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6012 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6013 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6014 are often the only way to detect them.
6015
6016 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6017 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6018
6019 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6020
6021
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006022option http-keep-alive
6023no option http-keep-alive
6024 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6026 yes | yes | yes | yes
6027 Arguments : none
6028
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006029 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6030 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006031 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6032 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6033 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6034 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6035 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006036
6037 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6038 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006039 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6040 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6041 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6042 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6043 situations where this option may be useful :
6044
6045 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006046 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006047
6048 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6049 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6050
6051 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6052 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6053 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6054 request.
6055
6056 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6057 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006058 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6059 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6060 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006061
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006062 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6063 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6064 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6065 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6066 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6067 not set.
6068
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006069 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006070 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6071 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006072
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006073 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006074 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006075 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006076
6077
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006078option http-no-delay
6079no option http-no-delay
6080 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6082 yes | yes | yes | yes
6083 Arguments : none
6084
6085 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6086 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6087 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6088 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6089 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6090 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6091 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6092 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6093 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6094 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6095 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6096 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6097 affected.
6098
6099 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6100 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6101 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6102 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6103 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6104 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6105 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6106 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6107 latency environments.
6108
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006109 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6110
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006111
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006112option http-pretend-keepalive
6113no option http-pretend-keepalive
6114 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006116 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006117 Arguments : none
6118
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006119 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006120 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6121 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6122 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6123 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6124 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6125 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6126 consider the response complete.
6127
6128 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6129 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6130 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6131 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006132 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006133 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6134
6135 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6136 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6137 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6138 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6139 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6140 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6141 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6142
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006143 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6144 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6145 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6146 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6147 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6148 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006149
6150 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6151 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6152
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006153 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006154 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006155
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006156
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006157option http-server-close
6158no option http-server-close
6159 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6161 yes | yes | yes | yes
6162 Arguments : none
6163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006164 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6165 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6166 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6167 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006168 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6169 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6170 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6171 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6172 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6173 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6174 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6175 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6176 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6177 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6178 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006179
6180 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6181 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6182 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6183 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006184 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6185 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006186
6187 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6188 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006189 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6190 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6191 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006192
6193 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6194 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006196 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6197 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006198
6199
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006200option http-tunnel
6201no option http-tunnel
6202 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
6203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006204 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006205 Arguments : none
6206
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006207 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6208 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6209 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6210 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006211 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006212
6213 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006214 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006215 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6216 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6217 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6218 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6219 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6220 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6221 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006222
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006223 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6224 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6225 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6226 backend.
6227
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006228 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6229 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6230
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006231 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6232 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006233
6234
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006235option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006236no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006237 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6239 yes | yes | yes | no
6240 Arguments : none
6241
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006242 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006243 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6244 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6245 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6246 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6247 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6248 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6249
6250 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6251 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006252 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6253 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6254 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006255
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006256 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6257 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6258 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6259 front of an existing proxy.
6260
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006261 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6262
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006263 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006264
6265
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006266option http-use-htx
6267no option http-use-htx
6268 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6270 yes | yes | yes | yes
6271 Arguments : none
6272
6273 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6274 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6275 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6276 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6277 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6278 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6279 representation.
6280
6281 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6282 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6283 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6284 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6285 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6286 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6287 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6288 other side's version.
6289
6290 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6291 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6292 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6293 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6294 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6295
6296 See also : "mode http"
6297
6298
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006299option httpchk
6300option httpchk <uri>
6301option httpchk <method> <uri>
6302option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6303 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6305 yes | no | yes | yes
6306 Arguments :
6307 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6308 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6309 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6310 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6311 ones.
6312
6313 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6314 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6315 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6316
6317 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6318 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6319 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6320 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6321 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6322
6323 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6324 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6325 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6326 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6327 the lack of any response.
6328
6329 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6330
6331 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6332 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6333 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6334
6335 Examples :
6336 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6337 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6338 backend https_relay
6339 mode tcp
6340 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6341 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6342
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006343 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6344 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6345 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006346
6347
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006348option httpclose
6349no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006350 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6352 yes | yes | yes | yes
6353 Arguments : none
6354
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006355 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6356 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6357 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6358 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006359 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006360
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006361 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6362 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6363 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6364 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6365 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006366
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006367 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6368 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6369 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006370
6371 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6372 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006373 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006374 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6375 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6376 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006377
6378 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6379 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6380
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006381 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006382
6383
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006384option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006385 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006387 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006388 Arguments :
6389 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6390 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6391 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006392 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006393 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006394
6395 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6396 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6397 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6398 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6399 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6400 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6401 ports.
6402
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006403 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6404 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006405
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006406 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006408 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006409
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006410
6411option http_proxy
6412no option http_proxy
6413 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6415 yes | yes | yes | yes
6416 Arguments : none
6417
6418 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6419 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6420 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6421 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6422 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6423
6424 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6425 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006426 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6427 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006428
6429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6431
6432 Example :
6433 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6434 backend direct_forward
6435 option httpclose
6436 option http_proxy
6437
6438 See also : "option httpclose"
6439
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006440
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006441option independent-streams
6442no option independent-streams
6443 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6445 yes | yes | yes | yes
6446 Arguments : none
6447
6448 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6449 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6450 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6451 receive data or not.
6452
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006453 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006454 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6455 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6456 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6457 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6458 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6459 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6460 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6461 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6462 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6463 socket buffers.
6464
6465 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6466 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6467 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6468 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6469 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6470
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006471 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006472 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6473 deprecated.
6474
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006475 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006476
6477
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006478option ldap-check
6479 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6481 yes | no | yes | yes
6482 Arguments : none
6483
6484 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6485 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6486 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6487 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6488
6489 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6490 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6491
6492 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6493 configure it.
6494
6495 Example :
6496 option ldap-check
6497
6498 See also : "option httpchk"
6499
6500
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006501option external-check
6502 Use external processes for server health checks
6503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6504 yes | no | yes | yes
6505
6506 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6507 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6508 command".
6509
6510 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6511
6512 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6513
6514
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006515option log-health-checks
6516no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006517 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6519 yes | no | yes | yes
6520 Arguments : none
6521
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006522 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6523 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6524 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006525
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006526 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6527 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6528 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6529 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6530 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6531
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006532 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006533 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006534
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006535 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6536 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6537 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006538
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006539
6540option log-separate-errors
6541no option log-separate-errors
6542 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6544 yes | yes | yes | no
6545 Arguments : none
6546
6547 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6548 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6549 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6550 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6551 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6552 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6553 provides very important information.
6554
6555 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6556 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6557 error logs.
6558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006559 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006560 logging.
6561
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006562
6563option logasap
6564no option logasap
6565 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6567 yes | yes | yes | no
6568 Arguments : none
6569
6570 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6571 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6572 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6573 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6574 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6575 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6576 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006577 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006578 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6579 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6580
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006581 Examples :
6582 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6583 mode http
6584 option httplog
6585 option logasap
6586 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6587
6588 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6589 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6590 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6591 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006593 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006594 logging.
6595
6596
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006597option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006598 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6600 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006601 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006602 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6603 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006604 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006605
6606 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6607 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006608 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006609 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6610 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6611 in the MySQL table, like this :
6612
6613 USE mysql;
6614 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6615 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6616
6617 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006618 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006619 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6620 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6621 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6622 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6623 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6624 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6625 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6626
6627 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6628 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006629
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006630 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006631
6632 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6633 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6634 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6635 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006636 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6637 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006638
6639 See also: "option httpchk"
6640
6641
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006642option nolinger
6643no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006644 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006645 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6646 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006647 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006648
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006649 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006650 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6651 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6652 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6653 connections.
6654
6655 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6656 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6657 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6658 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6659 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6660 this too.
6661
6662 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6663 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6664 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6665
6666 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6667 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6668 for servers.
6669
6670 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6671 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6672
6673
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006674option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6675 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6677 yes | yes | yes | yes
6678 Arguments :
6679 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6680 matching <network>
6681 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6682 header name.
6683
6684 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6685 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6686 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6687 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6688 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6689 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6690 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6691 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6692 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6693 possible that the client has already brought one.
6694
6695 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6696 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6697 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6698 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6699 header and requires different one.
6700
6701 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6702 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6703 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6704 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6705 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6706 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6707 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6708
6709 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6710 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6711 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6712 both are defined.
6713
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006714 Examples :
6715 # Original Destination address
6716 frontend www
6717 mode http
6718 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6719
6720 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6721 backend www
6722 mode http
6723 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6724
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006725 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006726
6727
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006728option persist
6729no option persist
6730 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6731 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6732 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006733 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006734
6735 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6736 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6737 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6738 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6739 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6740 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6741 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6742 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6743 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6744 redirected to another valid server.
6745
6746 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6747 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6748
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006749 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006750
6751
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006752option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6753 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6755 yes | no | yes | yes
6756 Arguments :
6757 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6758 PostgreSQL server.
6759
6760 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6761 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6762 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6763 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6764
6765 See also: "option httpchk"
6766
6767
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006768option prefer-last-server
6769no option prefer-last-server
6770 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6771 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6772 yes | no | yes | yes
6773 Arguments : none
6774
6775 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6776 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6777 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6778 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6779 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6780 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6781 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6782 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6783 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006784 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6785 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006786 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6787 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6788 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006789 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6790 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6791 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006792
6793 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6794 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6795
6796 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6797
6798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006799option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006800option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006801no option redispatch
6802 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6803 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6804 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006805 Arguments :
6806 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6807 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6808 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006809 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006810 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006811 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006812 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6813 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6814 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006816
6817 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6818 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6819 be able to access the service anymore.
6820
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006821 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6822 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006823
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006824 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006825 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6826 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006827
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006828 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6829 "redisp" keywords.
6830
6831 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6832 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6833
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006834 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006835
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006836
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006837option redis-check
6838 Use redis health checks for server testing
6839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6840 yes | no | yes | yes
6841 Arguments : none
6842
6843 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6844 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6845 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6846 find the "+PONG" response message.
6847
6848 Example :
6849 option redis-check
6850
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006851 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006852
6853
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006854option smtpchk
6855option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6856 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6858 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006859 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006860 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006861 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006862 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6863
6864 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6865 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6866 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6867
6868 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6869 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6870 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6871 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6872 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6873 dead server.
6874
6875 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6876 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006877 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006878 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6879
6880 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6881 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6882 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6883 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006884 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006885
6886 Example :
6887 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6888
6889 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006892option socket-stats
6893no option socket-stats
6894
6895 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6897 yes | yes | yes | no
6898
6899 Arguments : none
6900
6901
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006902option splice-auto
6903no option splice-auto
6904 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6906 yes | yes | yes | yes
6907 Arguments : none
6908
6909 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6910 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006911 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006912 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006913 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006914 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6915 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6916 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6917 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6918
6919 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6920 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6921 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6922 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6923 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6924 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6925 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6926 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6927 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6928 keyword.
6929
6930 Example :
6931 option splice-auto
6932
6933 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6934 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6935
6936 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6937 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6938
6939
6940option splice-request
6941no option splice-request
6942 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6944 yes | yes | yes | yes
6945 Arguments : none
6946
6947 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006948 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006949 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6950 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6951 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6952 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6953
6954 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6955
6956 Example :
6957 option splice-request
6958
6959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6961
6962 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6963 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6964
6965
6966option splice-response
6967no option splice-response
6968 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6970 yes | yes | yes | yes
6971 Arguments : none
6972
6973 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006974 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006975 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6976 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6977 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6978 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6979
6980 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6981
6982 Example :
6983 option splice-response
6984
6985 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6986 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6987
6988 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6989 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6990
6991
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006992option spop-check
6993 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6995 no | no | no | yes
6996 Arguments : none
6997
6998 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6999 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7000 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7001 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7002
7003 Example :
7004 option spop-check
7005
7006 See also : "option httpchk"
7007
7008
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007009option srvtcpka
7010no option srvtcpka
7011 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7013 yes | no | yes | yes
7014 Arguments : none
7015
7016 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7017 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007018 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007019 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7020
7021 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7022 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7023 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7024 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7025
7026 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7027 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7028 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7029 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7030 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7031
7032 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7033
7034 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7035 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7036 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7037
7038 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7039 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7040
7041 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7042
7043
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007044option ssl-hello-chk
7045 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7047 yes | no | yes | yes
7048 Arguments : none
7049
7050 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7051 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7052 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7053 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7054 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7055 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7056 hello message.
7057
7058 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7059 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7060 messages, which is appreciable.
7061
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007062 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7063 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7064 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007065
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007066 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7067
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007068
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007069option tcp-check
7070 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7071 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7072 yes | no | yes | yes
7073
7074 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7075 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7076
7077 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7078 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7079 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7080
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007081 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007082 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7083 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7084 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7085 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7086 only.
7087
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007088 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007089 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7090 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7091 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7092 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7093
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007094 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007095 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7096 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007097 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007098 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7099 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7100 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7101 the respective protocols.
7102 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007103 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007104
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007105 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7106 script.
7107
7108 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7109 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7110 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7111 The "comment" is of course optional.
7112
7113
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007114 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007115 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007116 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007117 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007118
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007119 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007120 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007121 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007122
7123 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7124 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007125 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007126 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007127 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007128 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007129 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007130 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007131 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7132 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007133 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007134 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7135 tcp-check expect string +OK
7136
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007137 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007138 (send many headers before analyzing)
7139 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007140 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007141 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7142 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7143 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7144 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007145 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007146
7147
7148 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7149
7150
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007151option tcp-smart-accept
7152no option tcp-smart-accept
7153 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7155 yes | yes | yes | no
7156 Arguments : none
7157
7158 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7159 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7160 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7161 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7162 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7163 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7164
7165 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7166 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7167 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7168 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7169
7170 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7171 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7172 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007173 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007174
7175 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7176 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7177 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7178
7179 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7180 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7181 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7182
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007183 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7184
7185
7186option tcp-smart-connect
7187no option tcp-smart-connect
7188 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7190 yes | no | yes | yes
7191 Arguments : none
7192
7193 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7194 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7195 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7196 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7197 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7198
7199 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7200 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7201 complex.
7202
7203 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7204 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7205 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7206
7207 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7208 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7209
7210 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7211
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007212
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007213option tcpka
7214 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7216 yes | yes | yes | yes
7217 Arguments : none
7218
7219 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7220 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007221 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007222 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7223
7224 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7225 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7226 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7227 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7228
7229 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7230 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7231 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7232 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7233 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7234
7235 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7236
7237 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7238 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7239 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7240 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7241 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7242 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7243 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7244 backends.
7245
7246 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7247
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007248
7249option tcplog
7250 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007252 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007253 Arguments : none
7254
7255 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7256 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7257 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7258 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7259 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7260 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7261 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7262 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7263
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007264 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007266 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007267
7268
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007269option transparent
7270no option transparent
7271 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007273 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007274 Arguments : none
7275
7276 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7277 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7278 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7279 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7280 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7281 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7282 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7283 appropriate server.
7284
7285 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7286 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7287
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007288 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007289 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007290
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007291
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007292external-check command <command>
7293 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7295 yes | no | yes | yes
7296
7297 Arguments :
7298 <command> is the external command to run
7299
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007300 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7301
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007302 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007303
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007304 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7305 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7306 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7307 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7308 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7309 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007310
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007311 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7312
7313 Environment variables :
7314 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7315 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7316
7317 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7318
7319 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7320
7321 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7322 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7323 for a UNIX socket).
7324
7325 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7326
7327 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7328
7329 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7330
7331 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7332
7333 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7334
7335 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7336 socket).
7337
7338 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7339 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7340
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007341 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7342 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7343 failed.
7344
7345 Example :
7346 external-check command /bin/true
7347
7348 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7349
7350
7351external-check path <path>
7352 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7354 yes | no | yes | yes
7355
7356 Arguments :
7357 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7358
7359 The default path is "".
7360
7361 Example :
7362 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7363
7364 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7365 "external-check command"
7366
7367
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007368persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007369persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007370 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7372 yes | no | yes | yes
7373 Arguments :
7374 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007375 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7376 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007377
7378 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7379 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007380 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007381 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7382 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7383 forwarded to this server.
7384
7385 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7386 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7387 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007388 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007389 a single "listen" section.
7390
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007391 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7392 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7393 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7394
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007395 Example :
7396 listen tse-farm
7397 bind :3389
7398 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7399 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7400 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7401 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7402 persist rdp-cookie
7403 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007404 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007405 balance rdp-cookie
7406 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7407 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7408
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007409 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7410 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007411
7412
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007413rate-limit sessions <rate>
7414 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7416 yes | yes | yes | no
7417 Arguments :
7418 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7419 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7420
7421 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7422 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7423 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7424 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7425 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7426 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7427
7428 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7429 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7430 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7431 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7432
7433 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7434 listen smtp
7435 mode tcp
7436 bind :25
7437 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007438 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007439
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007440 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7441 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7442 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007443
7444 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7445
7446
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007447redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7448redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7449redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007450 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7452 no | yes | yes | yes
7453
7454 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007455 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007456
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007457 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007458 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007459 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7460 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7461 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007462
7463 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7464 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7465 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7466 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7467 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007468 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7469 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7470 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7471 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007472
7473 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7474 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7475 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7476 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7477 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7478 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007479 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007480 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007481 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7482 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7483 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007484
7485 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007486 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7487 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7488 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007489 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007490 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7491 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7492 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7493 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007494
7495 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007496 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007497
7498 - "drop-query"
7499 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7500 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7501 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7502 with a location-type redirect.
7503
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007504 - "append-slash"
7505 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7506 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7507 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7508 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7509
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007510 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7511 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7512 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7513 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7514 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7515 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7516 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7517
7518 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7519 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7520 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7521 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7522 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7523 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7524 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007525
7526 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7527 acl clear dst_port 80
7528 acl secure dst_port 8080
7529 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007530 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007531 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007532 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7533
7534 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007535 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7536 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7537 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007538 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007539
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007540 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7541 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7542 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7543
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007544 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007545 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007546
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007547 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007548 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7549 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7550 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007552 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007553
7554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007555redisp (deprecated)
7556redispatch (deprecated)
7557 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7558 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7559 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007560 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007561
7562 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7563 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7564 be able to access the service anymore.
7565
7566 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7567 redistribute them to a working server.
7568
7569 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7570 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7571 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007573 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7574 "option redispatch" instead.
7575
7576 See also : "option redispatch"
7577
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007578
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007579reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007580 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7582 no | yes | yes | yes
7583 Arguments :
7584 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7585 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007586 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007587
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007588 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7589 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7590
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007591 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7592 the last header of an HTTP request.
7593
7594 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7595 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7596 responses.
7597
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007598 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7599 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7600 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7601
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007602 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7603 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007604
7605
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007606reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7607reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007608 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7610 no | yes | yes | yes
7611 Arguments :
7612 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7613 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7614 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7615 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7616 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7617 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7618 ignores case.
7619
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007620 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7621 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7622
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007623 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7624 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7625 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7626 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007627 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007628
7629 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7630 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7631
7632 Example :
7633 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7634 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7635 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7636
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007637 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7638 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007639
7640
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007641reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7642reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007643 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7645 no | yes | yes | yes
7646 Arguments :
7647 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7648 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7649 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7650 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7651 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7652 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7653
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007654 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7655 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7656
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007657 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7658 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7659 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7660 next servers.
7661
7662 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7663 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7664 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7665
7666 Example :
7667 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7668 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7669 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7670
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007671 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7672 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007673
7674
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007675reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7676reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007677 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7679 no | yes | yes | yes
7680 Arguments :
7681 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7682 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7683 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7684 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7685 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7686 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7687 case.
7688
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007689 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7690 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7691
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007692 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7693 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7694 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7695 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007696 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007697
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007698 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007699 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007700 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007701
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007702 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7703 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7704
7705 Example :
7706 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7707 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7708 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7709
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007710 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7711 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007712
7713
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007714reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7715reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007716 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7718 no | yes | yes | yes
7719 Arguments :
7720 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7721 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7722 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7723 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7724 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7725 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7726 case.
7727
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007728 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7729 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7730
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007731 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7732 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7733 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7734 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7735
7736 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7737 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7738
7739 Example :
7740 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7741 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7742 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7743 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7744
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007745 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7746 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007747
7748
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007749reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7750reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007751 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7753 no | yes | yes | yes
7754 Arguments :
7755 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7756 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7757 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7758 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7759 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7760 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7761
7762 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7763 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7764 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7765 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007766 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007767
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007768 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7769 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7770
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007771 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7772 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7773 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7774
7775 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7776 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7777 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7778 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7779 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7780
7781 Example :
7782 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007783 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007784 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7785 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7786
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007787 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7788 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007789
7790
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007791reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7792reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007793 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7795 no | yes | yes | yes
7796 Arguments :
7797 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7798 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7799 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7800 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7801 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7802 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7803 ignores case.
7804
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007805 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7806 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7807
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007808 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7809 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007810 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7811 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7812 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007813 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7814 not set.
7815
7816 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7817 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7818 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7819 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7820 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7821
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007822 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007823 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007824 # block all others.
7825 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7826 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7827
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007828 # block bad guys
7829 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7830 reqitarpit . if badguys
7831
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007832 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7833 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007834
7835
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007836retries <value>
7837 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7839 yes | no | yes | yes
7840 Arguments :
7841 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7842 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7843 default value is 3.
7844
7845 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7846 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7847 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7848
7849 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007850 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7851 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007852
7853 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7854 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7855
7856 See also : "option redispatch"
7857
7858
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007859rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007860 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7862 no | yes | yes | yes
7863 Arguments :
7864 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7865 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007866 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007867
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007868 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7869 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7870
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007871 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7872 the last header of an HTTP response.
7873
7874 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7875 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7876 responses.
7877
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007878 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7879 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007880
7881
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007882rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7883rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007884 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7886 no | yes | yes | yes
7887 Arguments :
7888 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7889 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7890 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7891 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7892 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7893 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7894 ignores case.
7895
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007896 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7897 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7898
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007899 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7900 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007901 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007902 client.
7903
7904 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7905 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7906 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7907
7908 Example :
7909 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007910 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007911
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007912 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7913 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007914
7915
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007916rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7917rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007918 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7920 no | yes | yes | yes
7921 Arguments :
7922 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7923 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7924 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7925 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7926 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7927 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7928 ignores case.
7929
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007930 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7931 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7932
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007933 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7934 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7935 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7936 case-sensitive.
7937
7938 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007939 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7940 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7941 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007942
7943 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7944 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7945
7946 Example :
7947 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7948 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7949
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007950 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7951 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007952
7953
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007954rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7955rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007956 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7958 no | yes | yes | yes
7959 Arguments :
7960 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7961 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7962 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7963 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7964 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7965 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7966 ignores case.
7967
7968 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7969 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7970 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7971 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007972 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007973
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007974 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7975 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7976
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007977 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7978 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7979 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7980
7981 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7982 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7983 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7984 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7985 are not case-sensitive.
7986
7987 Example :
7988 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7989 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7990
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007991 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7992 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007993
7994
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007995server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007996 Declare a server in a backend
7997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7998 no | no | yes | yes
7999 Arguments :
8000 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008001 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008002 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008003
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008004 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8005 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8006 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8007 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008008 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8009 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8010 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8011 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8012 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008013 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8014 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8015 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8016 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8017 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8018 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8019 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008020 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008021 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8022 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8023 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8024 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8025 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8026 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008027 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8028 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008029 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8030 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008031
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008032 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008033 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8034 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8035 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8036 adding this value to the client's port.
8037
8038 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8039 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008040 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008041
8042 Examples :
8043 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8044 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008045 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008046 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8047 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8048 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008049
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008050 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8051 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8052 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8053 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8054 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8055
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008056 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8057 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008058
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008059server-state-file-name [<file>]
8060 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8061 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8062 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8063 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8064 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8065 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8066
8067 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8068 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8069
8070 global
8071 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8072
8073 backend bk
8074 load-server-state-from-file
8075
8076 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8077 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008078
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008079server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8080 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8081 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8083 no | no | yes | yes
8084
8085 Arguments:
8086 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8087
8088 <num | range>
8089 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8090 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8091 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8092 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8093
8094 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8095
8096 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8097
8098 <params*>
8099 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8100 keyword.
8101
8102 Examples:
8103 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8104 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8105 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8106
8107 # or
8108 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8109
8110 # would be equivalent to:
8111 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8112 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8113 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8114
8115
8116
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008117source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008118source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008119source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008120 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8122 yes | no | yes | yes
8123 Arguments :
8124 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8125 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008126
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008127 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008128 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8129 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8130 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8131 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8132 supported prefixes are :
8133 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8134 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8135 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008136 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008137 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8138 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008139
8140 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8141 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008142 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8143 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8144 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008145
8146 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8147 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8148 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8149 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8150 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8151 <addr>.
8152
8153 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8154 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8155 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8156 port.
8157
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008158 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8159 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8160 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8161 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008162 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008163 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8164 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8165 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8166 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8167 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8168 HTTP header.
8169
8170 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8171 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008172 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008173 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8174 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8175 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8176 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8177 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8178 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8179 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8180
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008181 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8182 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8183 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8184 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8185 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8186 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8187
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008188 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8189 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8190 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8191 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8192
8193 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8194 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8195 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8196 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8197 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8198 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8199
8200 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8201 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8202 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8203 there are two methods :
8204
8205 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8206 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8207 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8208 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8209 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8210 of the client ranges may be used.
8211
8212 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8213 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8214 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8215 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8216 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8217 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8218 same session.
8219
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008220 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8221 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8222 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008223 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008224
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008225 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8226
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008227 Examples :
8228 backend private
8229 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8230 source 192.168.1.200
8231
8232 backend transparent_ssl1
8233 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8234 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8235
8236 backend transparent_ssl2
8237 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8238 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8239 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8240
8241 backend transparent_ssl3
8242 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8243 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8244 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8245
8246 backend transparent_smtp
8247 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8248 # with Tproxy version 4.
8249 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8250
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008251 backend transparent_http
8252 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8253 # proxy.
8254 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008256 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008257 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8258
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008259
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008260srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8261 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8263 yes | no | yes | yes
8264 Arguments :
8265 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8266 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8267 as explained at the top of this document.
8268
8269 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8270 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8271 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8272 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8273 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8274 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8275 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8276
8277 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8278 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8279 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8280 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8281 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008282 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008283 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008284 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008285
8286 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8287 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8288 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8289 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8290 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8291 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8292
8293 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8294 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8295
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008296 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8297 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008298
8299
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008300stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8301 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008303 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008304
8305 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8306 matched.
8307
8308 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8309 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8310
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008311 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8312 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008313 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008314
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008315 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8316 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8317 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8318 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008319
8320 Example :
8321 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8322 backend stats_localhost
8323 stats enable
8324 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8325
8326 Example :
8327 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8328 backend stats_auth
8329 stats enable
8330 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8331 stats admin if TRUE
8332
8333 Example :
8334 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8335 userlist stats-auth
8336 group admin users admin
8337 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8338 group readonly users haproxy
8339 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8340
8341 backend stats_auth
8342 stats enable
8343 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8344 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8345 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8346 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8347
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008348 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8349 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8350 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008351
8352
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008353stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8354 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008356 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008357 Arguments :
8358 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8359
8360 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8361
8362 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8363 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8364 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8365 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8366 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8367 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8368
8369 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8370 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8371 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008372 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008373
8374 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8375 report using "stats scope".
8376
8377 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8378 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8379 unobvious parameters.
8380
8381 Example :
8382 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8383 backend public_www
8384 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8385 stats enable
8386 stats hide-version
8387 stats scope .
8388 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008389 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008390 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8391 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8392
8393 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8394 backend private_monitoring
8395 stats enable
8396 stats uri /admin?stats
8397 stats refresh 5s
8398
8399 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8400
8401
8402stats enable
8403 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008405 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008406 Arguments : none
8407
8408 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8409 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8410 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8411 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8412 - stats auth : no authentication
8413 - stats scope : no restriction
8414
8415 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8416 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8417 unobvious parameters.
8418
8419 Example :
8420 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8421 backend public_www
8422 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8423 stats enable
8424 stats hide-version
8425 stats scope .
8426 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008427 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008428 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8429 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8430
8431 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8432 backend private_monitoring
8433 stats enable
8434 stats uri /admin?stats
8435 stats refresh 5s
8436
8437 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8438
8439
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008440stats hide-version
8441 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008443 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008444 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008445
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008446 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8447 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8448 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8449 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8450 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8451 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008452
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008453 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8454 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8455 unobvious parameters.
8456
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008457 Example :
8458 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8459 backend public_www
8460 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008461 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008462 stats hide-version
8463 stats scope .
8464 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008465 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008466 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8467 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008468
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008469 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8470 backend private_monitoring
8471 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008472 stats uri /admin?stats
8473 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008474
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008475 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008476
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008477
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008478stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8479 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8480 Access control for statistics
8481
8482 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8483 no | no | yes | yes
8484
8485 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8486 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8487 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8488 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8489 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8490 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8491
8492 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8493 instance.
8494
8495 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8496 about ACL usage.
8497
8498
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008499stats realm <realm>
8500 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008502 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008503 Arguments :
8504 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8505 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8506 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8507
8508 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8509 using a backslash ('\').
8510
8511 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8512 only related to authentication.
8513
8514 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8515 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8516 unobvious parameters.
8517
8518 Example :
8519 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8520 backend public_www
8521 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8522 stats enable
8523 stats hide-version
8524 stats scope .
8525 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008526 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008527 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8528 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8529
8530 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8531 backend private_monitoring
8532 stats enable
8533 stats uri /admin?stats
8534 stats refresh 5s
8535
8536 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8537
8538
8539stats refresh <delay>
8540 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008542 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008543 Arguments :
8544 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8545 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8546 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8547 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8548 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8549 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8550
8551 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8552 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8553 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8554 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8555
8556 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8557 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8558 unobvious parameters.
8559
8560 Example :
8561 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8562 backend public_www
8563 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8564 stats enable
8565 stats hide-version
8566 stats scope .
8567 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008568 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008569 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8570 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8571
8572 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8573 backend private_monitoring
8574 stats enable
8575 stats uri /admin?stats
8576 stats refresh 5s
8577
8578 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8579
8580
8581stats scope { <name> | "." }
8582 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008584 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008585 Arguments :
8586 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8587 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8588 section in which the statement appears.
8589
8590 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8591 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8592 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8593 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8594 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8595 exists.
8596
8597 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8598 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8599 unobvious parameters.
8600
8601 Example :
8602 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8603 backend public_www
8604 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8605 stats enable
8606 stats hide-version
8607 stats scope .
8608 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008609 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008610 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8611 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8612
8613 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8614 backend private_monitoring
8615 stats enable
8616 stats uri /admin?stats
8617 stats refresh 5s
8618
8619 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8620
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008621
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008622stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008623 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008625 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008626
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008627 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008628 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8629
8630 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8631 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8632
8633 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8634 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008635 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008636
8637 Example :
8638 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8639 backend private_monitoring
8640 stats enable
8641 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8642 stats uri /admin?stats
8643 stats refresh 5s
8644
8645 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8646 global section.
8647
8648
8649stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008650 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8652 yes | yes | yes | yes
8653 Arguments : none
8654
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008655 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008656 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8657 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8658 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8659 - IP (socket, server)
8660 - cookie (backend, server)
8661
8662 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8663 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008664 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008665
8666 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8667
8668
8669stats show-node [ <name> ]
8670 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008672 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008673 Arguments:
8674 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8675 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8676
8677 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8678 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008679 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008680
8681 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8682 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8683 unobvious parameters.
8684
8685 Example:
8686 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8687 backend private_monitoring
8688 stats enable
8689 stats show-node Europe-1
8690 stats uri /admin?stats
8691 stats refresh 5s
8692
8693 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8694 section.
8695
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008696
8697stats uri <prefix>
8698 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008700 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008701 Arguments :
8702 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8703 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8704 query string.
8705
8706 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8707 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8708 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8709 possible to reach it in the application.
8710
8711 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008712 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008713 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8714 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8715 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8716 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8717
8718 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8719 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8720 an address or a port to statistics only.
8721
8722 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8723 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8724 unobvious parameters.
8725
8726 Example :
8727 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8728 backend public_www
8729 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8730 stats enable
8731 stats hide-version
8732 stats scope .
8733 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008734 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008735 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8736 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8737
8738 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8739 backend private_monitoring
8740 stats enable
8741 stats uri /admin?stats
8742 stats refresh 5s
8743
8744 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8745
8746
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008747stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8748 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008750 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008751
8752 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008753 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008754 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008755 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008756 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8757
8758 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8759 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8760 the "stick-table" statement.
8761
8762 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8763 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8764 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8765 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8766 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8767
8768 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8769 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8770 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8771 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8772 transformation rules.
8773
8774 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8775 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8776 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8777 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8778 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8779 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8780 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8781
8782 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8783 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8784 ACL based conditions.
8785
8786 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8787 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8788 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8789 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8790
8791 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8792 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8793 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8794 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8795
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008796 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8797 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008798 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008799
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008800 Example :
8801 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8802 # last 30 minutes
8803 backend pop
8804 mode tcp
8805 balance roundrobin
8806 stick store-request src
8807 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8808 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8809 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8810
8811 backend smtp
8812 mode tcp
8813 balance roundrobin
8814 stick match src table pop
8815 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8816 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8817
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008818 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008819 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008820
8821
8822stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8823 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8825 no | no | yes | yes
8826
8827 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8828 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8829 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8830 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8831
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008832 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8833 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008834 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008835
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008836 Examples :
8837 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008838 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008839
8840 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8841 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8842 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8843
8844
8845 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8846 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8847 backend http
8848 mode http
8849 balance roundrobin
8850 stick on src table https
8851 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8852 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8853 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8854
8855 backend https
8856 mode tcp
8857 balance roundrobin
8858 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8859 stick on src
8860 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8861 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8862
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008863 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008864
8865
8866stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8867 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8869 no | no | yes | yes
8870
8871 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008872 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008873 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008874 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008875 server is selected.
8876
8877 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8878 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8879 the "stick-table" statement.
8880
8881 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8882 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8883 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8884 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8885 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8886 address.
8887
8888 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8889 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8890 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8891 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8892 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8893 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8894 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8895 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8896 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8897 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8898
8899 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8900 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8901 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8902 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8903 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8904 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8905 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8906
8907 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8908 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8909 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8910 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8911
8912 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8913 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8914 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8915 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8916 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8917 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008918 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8919 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8920 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8921 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8922 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8923 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008924
8925 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8926 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8927 the request.
8928
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008929 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8930 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008931 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008932
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008933 Example :
8934 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8935 # last 30 minutes
8936 backend pop
8937 mode tcp
8938 balance roundrobin
8939 stick store-request src
8940 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8941 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8942 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8943
8944 backend smtp
8945 mode tcp
8946 balance roundrobin
8947 stick match src table pop
8948 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8949 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8950
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008951 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008952 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008953
8954
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008955stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008956 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8957 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008958 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008960 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008961
8962 Arguments :
8963 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8964 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8965 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8966 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8967
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008968 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8969 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8970 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8971 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8972
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008973 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8974 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8975 instance.
8976
8977 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8978 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8979 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8980 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8981 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8982 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008983 to 32 characters.
8984
8985 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8986 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8987 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008988 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008989 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8990 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008991
8992 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008993 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8994 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008995 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8996 increase.
8997
8998 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008999 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9000 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9001 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009002
9003 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9004 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9005 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9006 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009007 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009008 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9009 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9010 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9011 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9012 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9013 parameter (see below).
9014
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009015 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9016 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9017 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9018 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9019 soft restart.
9020
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009021 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9022 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009023
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009024 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9025 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9026 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9027 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009028 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009029 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009030 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9031 if not expiration delay is specified.
9032
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009033 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9034 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9035 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9036 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009037 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9038 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9039 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9040 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9041 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9042 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9043 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9044 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9045 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9046 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9047 types and their arguments.
9048
9049 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9050 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9051 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9052 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9053
9054 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9055 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9056 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009057 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009058
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009059 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9060 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9061 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009062 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009063 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009064 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009065
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009066 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9067 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9068 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9069 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9070
9071 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9072 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9073 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9074 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9075 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9076 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9077
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009078 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9079 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9080 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9081 they were received.
9082
9083 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9084 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9085 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9086 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9087 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9088
9089 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9090 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9091 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9092 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9093 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9094
9095 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9096 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9097 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9098
9099 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9100 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9101 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9102 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9103 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9104
9105 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9106 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9107 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9108 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9109 the client side.
9110
9111 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9112 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9113 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9114 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9115 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9116 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9117 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9118
9119 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9120 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9121 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9122 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9123 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9124 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009125 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009126
9127 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9128 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9129 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9130 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9131 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9132 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9133
9134 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009135 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009136 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9137 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9138
9139 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9140 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9141 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9142 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9143 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9144 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9145 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9146 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9147 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9148 recommended for better fairness.
9149
9150 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009151 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009152 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9153 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9154
9155 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9156 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9157 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9158 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9159 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9160 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9161 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9162 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9163 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9164 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009165
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009166 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9167 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009168 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9169 reference it.
9170
9171 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9172 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009173 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9174 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9175 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009176
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009177 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9178 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9179 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9180 something that can be ignored.
9181
9182 Example:
9183 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9184 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9185 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9186 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9187
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009188 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009189 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009190
9191
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009192stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009193 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9195 no | no | yes | yes
9196
9197 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009198 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009199 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009200 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009201 server is selected.
9202
9203 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9204 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9205 the "stick-table" statement.
9206
9207 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9208 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9209 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9210 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9211
9212 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9213 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9214 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9215 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9216 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9217 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009218 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009219 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9220 rules.
9221
9222 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9223 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9224 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9225 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9226 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9227 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9228 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9229
9230 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9231 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9232 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9233 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9234
9235 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9236 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9237 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9238 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9239 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9240 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009241 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9242 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9243 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9244 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9245 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9246 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9247 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9248 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9249 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009250
9251 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9252
9253 Example :
9254 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9255 backend https
9256 mode tcp
9257 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009258 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009259 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009260
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009261 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9262 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9263
9264 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9265 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9266 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9267
9268 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9269 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009270
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009271 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9272 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9273 # at offset 44.
9274
9275 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9276 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9277
9278 # Learn on response if server hello.
9279 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009280
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009281 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9282 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9283
9284 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9285 extraction.
9286
9287
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009288tcp-check connect [params*]
9289 Opens a new connection
9290 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9291 no | no | yes | yes
9292
9293 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9294 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9295 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9296
9297 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9298 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9299 of the sequence.
9300
9301 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9302 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9303 do.
9304
9305 Parameters :
9306 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9307 use the TCP connection.
9308
9309 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9310 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9311 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9312
9313 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9314
9315 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9316
9317 Examples:
9318 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9319 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9320 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9321 option tcp-check
9322 tcp-check connect
9323 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9324 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9325 tcp-check send \r\n
9326 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9327 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9328 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9329 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9330 tcp-check send \r\n
9331 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9332 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9333
9334 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9335 option tcp-check
9336 tcp-check connect port 110
9337 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9338 tcp-check connect port 143
9339 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9340 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9341
9342 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9343
9344
9345tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009346 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009347 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9348 no | no | yes | yes
9349
9350 Arguments :
9351 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9352 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9353 binary.
9354 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9355 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9356 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9357
9358 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9359 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9360 with the usual backslash ('\').
9361 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009362 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009363 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9364 used upper or lower case.
9365
9366
9367 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9368
9369 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9370 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9371 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9372 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9373 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9374 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9375 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9376 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9377
9378 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9379 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9380 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9381 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9382 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9383 expression.
9384
9385 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9386 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9387 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9388 this exact hexadecimal string.
9389 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9390
9391 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9392 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9393 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9394 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9395 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9396 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9397 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9398 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9399 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9400 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9401 the null character.
9402
9403 Examples :
9404 # perform a POP check
9405 option tcp-check
9406 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9407
9408 # perform an IMAP check
9409 option tcp-check
9410 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9411
9412 # look for the redis master server
9413 option tcp-check
9414 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009415 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009416 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9417 tcp-check expect string role:master
9418 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9419 tcp-check expect string +OK
9420
9421
9422 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9423 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9424
9425
9426tcp-check send <data>
9427 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9428 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9429 no | no | yes | yes
9430
9431 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9432 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9433
9434 Examples :
9435 # look for the redis master server
9436 option tcp-check
9437 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9438 tcp-check expect string role:master
9439
9440 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9441 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9442
9443
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009444tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9445 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009446 tcp health check
9447 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9448 no | no | yes | yes
9449
9450 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9451 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009452 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009453 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9454 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9455 hexadecimal string.
9456 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9457
9458 Examples :
9459 # redis check in binary
9460 option tcp-check
9461 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9462 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9463
9464
9465 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9466 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9467
9468
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009469tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9470 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9472 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009473 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009474 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9475 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009476
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009477 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009478
9479 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9480 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009481 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9482 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9483 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9484 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9485 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9486 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009487
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009488 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9489 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9490 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9491 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009492
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009493 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009494 - accept :
9495 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9496 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9497 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009498
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009499 - reject :
9500 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9501 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9502 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9503 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9504 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9505 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9506 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9507 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9508 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9509 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9510 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009511 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009512
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009513 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9514 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9515 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9516 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9517 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9518 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9519 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9520 hosts.
9521
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009522 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9523 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9524 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9525 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9526 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9527 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9528 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9529 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9530
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009531 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9532 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9533 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9534 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9535 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9536 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9537 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9538 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9539 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009540 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9541 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009542
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009543 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009544 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009545 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9546 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9547 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9548 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9549 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9550 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9551 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9552 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9553 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9554 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9555 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9556 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009557
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009558 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009559 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009560 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009561 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009562 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9563 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9564 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009565
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009566 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9567 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9568 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9569 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009571 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9572 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9573 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9574 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9575 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009576 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9577 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9578 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9579 layer7 information is extracted.
9580
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009581 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9582 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9583 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9584 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9585 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009586
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009587 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9588 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9589 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9590 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9591
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009592 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9593 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9594 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9595 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9596
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009597 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9598 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9599 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9600 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9601 continues.
9602
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009603 - set-src <expr> :
9604 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9605 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9606 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009607 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009608
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009609 Arguments:
9610 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9611 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009612
9613 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009614 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9615
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009616 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9617 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009618
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009619 - set-src-port <expr> :
9620 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9621 expression.
9622
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009623 Arguments:
9624 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9625 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009626
9627 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009628 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9629
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009630 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9631 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9632 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009633
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009634 - set-dst <expr> :
9635 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9636 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9637 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9638 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9639 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9640
9641 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9642 followed by some converters.
9643
9644 Example:
9645
9646 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9647 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9648
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009649 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9650 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9651
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009652 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9653 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9654 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9655 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9656
9657
9658 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9659 followed by some converters.
9660
9661 Example:
9662
9663 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9664
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009665 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9666 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9667 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9668
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009669 - "silent-drop" :
9670 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009671 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009672 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9673 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9674 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9675 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9676 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009677 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9678 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009679 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9680 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009681 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009682 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9683 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9684 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9685 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9686
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009687 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9688 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9689 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009690
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009691 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9692 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9693 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009694
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009695 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009696 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009697 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009698
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009699 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9700 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9701 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009702
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009703 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009704 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9705 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009706
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009707 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9708
9709 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9710
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009711 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9712
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009713 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009714
9715
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009716tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9717 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009719 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009720 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009721 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9722 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009723
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009724 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009725
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009726 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009727 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9728 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9729 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9730 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009731
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009732 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9733 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9734 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9735 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009736 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9737 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9738 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9739 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9740 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9741 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009742 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009743 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009744
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009745 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9746 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9747 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9748 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009749
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009750 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009751 - accept : the request is accepted
9752 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9753 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009754 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009755 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009756 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009757 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009758 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009759 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009760 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009761 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009762 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009763
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009764 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9765 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009766
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009767 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9768 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9769 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9770 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9771 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9772 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009774 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009775 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9776 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009777
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009778 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009779 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9780 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9781 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9782 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009783 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9784 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9785 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009786
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009787 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009788 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9789 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9790 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009791
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009792 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009793 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9794 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009795
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009796 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9797 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009798 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009799 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9800 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009801 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009802 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009803 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009804 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9805 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009806 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009807 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9808 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009809
9810 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9811 followed by some converters.
9812
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009813 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9814 <var-name>.
9815
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009816 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9817 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9818 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9819 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9820 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9821
9822 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9823 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9824 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9825 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9826 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9827 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9828 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9829 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9830 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9831 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9832 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9833
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009834 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9835 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9836 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9837 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9838 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9839
9840 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9841
9842 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9843
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009844 Example:
9845
9846 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009847 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009848
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009849 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009850 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9851 # and reject everything else.
9852 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9853 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009854 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009855 tcp-request content reject
9856
9857 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009858 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9859 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9860 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009861 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009862
9863 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9864 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9865 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009866 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009867 tcp-request content reject
9868
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009869 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009870 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009871 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009872 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009873 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9874 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009875
9876 Example:
9877 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9878 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009879 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009880
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009881 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009882 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009883
9884 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009885 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009886 # protecting all our sites
9887 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009888 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9889 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009890 ...
9891 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9892
9893 backend http_dynamic
9894 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009895 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009896 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009897 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009898 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009899 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009900 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009902 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009903
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009904 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9905 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009906
9907
9908tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9909 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009911 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009912 Arguments :
9913 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9914 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9915 as explained at the top of this document.
9916
9917 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9918 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9919 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9920 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9921 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9922
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009923 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9924 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9925 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9926 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9927
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009928 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9929 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009930 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009931 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009932 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9933 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9934 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9935 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009936
9937 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9938 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9939 it pass through unaffected.
9940
9941 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9942 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9943 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009944 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009945 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9946 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009947 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9948 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9949 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009950
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009951 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009952 "timeout client".
9953
9954
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009955tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9956 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9958 no | no | yes | yes
9959 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009960 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9961 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009962
9963 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9964
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009965 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009966 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9967 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009968 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9969 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009970
9971 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9972
9973 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9974 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9975 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9976 inserted.
9977
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009978 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009979 - accept :
9980 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9981 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9982 the rules evaluation.
9983
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009984 - close :
9985 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9986 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9987 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9988 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9989 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9990 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009991 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009992 protocols.
9993
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009994 - reject :
9995 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9996 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009997 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009998
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009999 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10000 Sets a variable.
10001
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010002 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10003 Unsets a variable.
10004
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010005 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10006 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10007 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10008 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10009
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010010 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10011 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10012 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10013 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10014
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010015 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10016 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10017 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10018 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10019 continues.
10020
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010021 - "silent-drop" :
10022 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010023 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010024 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10025 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10026 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10027 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10028 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010029 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10030 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010031 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10032 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010033 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010034 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10035 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10036 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10037 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10038
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010039 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10040 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10041
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010042 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10043 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10044 for changing the default action to a reject.
10045
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010046 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10047 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10048 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10049 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010050 period.
10051
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010052 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10053 declared inline.
10054
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010055 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10056 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010057 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010058 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10059 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010060 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010061 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010062 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010063 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10064 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010065 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010066 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10067 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010068
10069 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10070 followed by some converters.
10071
10072 Example:
10073
10074 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10075
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010076 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10077 <var-name>.
10078
10079 Example:
10080
10081 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10082
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010083 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10084 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10085 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10086 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10087 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10088
10089 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10090
10091 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10092
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010093 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10094
10095 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10096
10097
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010098tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10099 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10101 no | yes | yes | no
10102 Arguments :
10103 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10104 below.
10105
10106 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10107
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010108 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010109 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10110 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10111 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10112 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10113 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10114 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10115 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010116 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010117 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10118 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10119 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10120 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10121 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10122 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10123 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10124 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10125 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10126 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10127 instead.
10128
10129 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10130 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10131 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10132 rules which may be inserted.
10133
10134 Several types of actions are supported :
10135 - accept : the request is accepted
10136 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10137 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10138 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010139 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010140 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10141 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010142 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010143 - silent-drop
10144
10145 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10146 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10147 sections for a complete description.
10148
10149 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10150 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10151 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10152
10153 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10154 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10155 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10156 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10157 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10158
10159 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10160 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10161
10162 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10163 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10164 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10165
10166 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10167 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10168 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10169
10170 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10171 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10172 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10173
10174 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10175 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10176 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10177
10178 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10179
10180 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10181
10182
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010183tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10184 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10186 no | no | yes | yes
10187 Arguments :
10188 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10189 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10190 as explained at the top of this document.
10191
10192 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10193
10194
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010195timeout check <timeout>
10196 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10197 established.
10198
10199 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10200 yes | no | yes | yes
10201 Arguments:
10202 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10203 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10204 as explained at the top of this document.
10205
10206 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10207 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010208 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010209 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010210 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10211 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10212 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010213
10214 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10215 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10216
10217 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10218 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010219 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010220
10221 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10222 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10223 forget about it.
10224
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010225 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10226 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010227
10228
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010229timeout client <timeout>
10230timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10231 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10233 yes | yes | yes | no
10234 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010235 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010236 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10237 as explained at the top of this document.
10238
10239 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10240 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10241 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010242 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10243 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10244 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10245 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010246 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10247 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10248 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010249 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010250 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010251 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10252 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010253 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10254 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010255
10256 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10257 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10258 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10259 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10260 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10261 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010263 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010264
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010265 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10266 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10267 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10268
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010269 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10270 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010271
10272
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010273timeout client-fin <timeout>
10274 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10276 yes | yes | yes | no
10277 Arguments :
10278 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10279 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10280 as explained at the top of this document.
10281
10282 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10283 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10284 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10285 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10286 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10287 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10288 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010289 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10290 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10291 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010292
10293 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10294 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10295 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10296
10297 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10298
10299
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010300timeout connect <timeout>
10301timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10302 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10304 yes | no | yes | yes
10305 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010306 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010307 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10308 as explained at the top of this document.
10309
10310 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010311 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010312 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010313 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010314 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10315 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010316
10317 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10318 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10319 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10320 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10321 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10322 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10323
10324 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10325 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10326 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10327
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010328 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10329 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010330
10331
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010332timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10333 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10335 yes | yes | yes | yes
10336 Arguments :
10337 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10338 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10339 as explained at the top of this document.
10340
10341 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10342 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10343 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10344 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10345 once the request has started to present itself.
10346
10347 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10348 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10349 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10350 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10351 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10352
10353 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10354 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10355 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10356 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10357
10358 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10359 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010360 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010361 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10362 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010363 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010364
10365 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10366 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10367 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10368 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10369
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010370 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10371 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010372 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10373
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010374 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10375
10376
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010377timeout http-request <timeout>
10378 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010380 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010381 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010382 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010383 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10384 as explained at the top of this document.
10385
10386 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10387 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10388 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10389 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10390 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10391 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10392 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010393 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10394 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10395 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10396 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010397 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010398 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10399 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010400
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010401 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10402 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10403 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10404 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10405 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010406 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010407
10408 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10409 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010410 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010411 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10412 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10413
10414 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010415 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10416 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10417 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010418
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010419 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010420 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010421
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010422
10423timeout queue <timeout>
10424 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10426 yes | no | yes | yes
10427 Arguments :
10428 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10429 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10430 as explained at the top of this document.
10431
10432 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10433 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10434 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10435 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10436 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10437
10438 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10439 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10440 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10441 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10442
10443 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10444
10445
10446timeout server <timeout>
10447timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10448 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10450 yes | no | yes | yes
10451 Arguments :
10452 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10453 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10454 as explained at the top of this document.
10455
10456 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10457 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10458 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10459 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10460 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10461 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10462 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10463
10464 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10465 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10466 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10467 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10468 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010469 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010470 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010471 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10472 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010473 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10474 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010475
10476 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10477 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10478 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10479 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10480 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10481 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10482
10483 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10484 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10485 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10486
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010487 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010488
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010489
10490timeout server-fin <timeout>
10491 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10493 yes | no | yes | yes
10494 Arguments :
10495 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10496 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10497 as explained at the top of this document.
10498
10499 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10500 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10501 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10502 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10503 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10504 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10505 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10506 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10507 situations, it should not be needed.
10508
10509 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10510 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10511 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10512
10513 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10514
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010515
10516timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010517 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10519 yes | yes | yes | yes
10520 Arguments :
10521 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10522 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10523 as explained at the top of this document.
10524
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010525 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10526 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10527 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10528 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010529
10530 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10531 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10532 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10533 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010534 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010535
10536 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10537
10538
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010539timeout tunnel <timeout>
10540 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10542 yes | no | yes | yes
10543 Arguments :
10544 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10545 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10546 as explained at the top of this document.
10547
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010548 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010549 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10550 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10551 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010552 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10553 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010554 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10555 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10556 specified.
10557
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010558 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10559 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10560 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10561 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10562 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10563 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10564 state.
10565
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010566 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10567 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10568 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10569 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010570 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010571
10572 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10573 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10574 forget about it.
10575
10576 Example :
10577 defaults http
10578 option http-server-close
10579 timeout connect 5s
10580 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010581 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010582 timeout server 30s
10583 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10584
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010585 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010586
10587
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010588transparent (deprecated)
10589 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010591 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010592 Arguments : none
10593
10594 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10595 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10596 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10597 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10598 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10599 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10600 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10601 appropriate server.
10602
10603 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10604
10605 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10606 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10607
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010608 See also: "option transparent"
10609
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010610unique-id-format <string>
10611 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10613 yes | yes | yes | no
10614 Arguments :
10615 <string> is a log-format string.
10616
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010617 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10618 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10619 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10620 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010621
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010622 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10623 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10624 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10625 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10626 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10627 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10628 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10629 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010630
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010631 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10632 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010633
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010634 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010635
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010636 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010637
10638 will generate:
10639
10640 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10641
10642 See also: "unique-id-header"
10643
10644unique-id-header <name>
10645 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10647 yes | yes | yes | no
10648 Arguments :
10649 <name> is the name of the header.
10650
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010651 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10652 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010653
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010654 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010655
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010656 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010657 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10658
10659 will generate:
10660
10661 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10662
10663 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010664
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010665use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010666 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10668 no | yes | yes | no
10669 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010670 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10671 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010672
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010673 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10674 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010675
10676 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10677 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10678 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010679 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010680 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010681 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10682 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010683
10684 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10685 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10686 assign the backend.
10687
10688 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10689 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10690 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10691 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10692 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10693 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10694
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010695 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010696 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010697 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10698 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10699 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10700
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010701 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10702 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10703 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10704 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10705 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10706 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10707 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10708 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10709 cannot be forced from the request.
10710
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010711 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010712 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10713 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10714
10715 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10716 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010717
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010718
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010719use-server <server> if <condition>
10720use-server <server> unless <condition>
10721 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10723 no | no | yes | yes
10724 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010725 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010726
10727 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10728
10729 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10730 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10731 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10732
10733 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10734 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10735 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10736 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10737 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10738 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10739 matches will assign the server.
10740
10741 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10742 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10743 with the next rules until one matches.
10744
10745 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10746 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10747 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10748 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10749
10750 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10751 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10752 stripped.
10753
10754 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10755 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10756 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10757 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10758
10759 Example :
10760 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10761 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10762 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10763 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10764 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10765 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010766 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010767 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10768 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10769
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010770 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010771
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010772
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107735. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010774--------------------------
10775
10776The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10777depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10778settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10779written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10780described in this section.
10781
10782
107835.1. Bind options
10784-----------------
10785
10786The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10787as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10788no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10789parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10790while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10791provided immediately after the setting name.
10792
10793The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10794
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010795accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10796 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10797 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10798 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10799 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10800 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10801 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10802 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10803 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10804 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010805 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10806 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10807 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010808
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010809accept-proxy
10810 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010811 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10812 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010813 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10814 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10815 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10816 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010817 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010818 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10819 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010820 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10821 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010822
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010823allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010824 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010825 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10826 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10827 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10828 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010829
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010830alpn <protocols>
10831 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10832 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10833 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10834 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10835 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010836 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10837 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10838 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10839 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10840 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10841 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10842 preference, like below :
10843
10844 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010845
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010846backlog <backlog>
10847 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10848 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10849
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010850curves <curves>
10851 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10852 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10853 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10854 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10855 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10856 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10857
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010858ecdhe <named curve>
10859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010860 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10861 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010862
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010863ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10865 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10866 client's certificate.
10867
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010868ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10869 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10870 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10871 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10872 error is ignored.
10873
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010874ca-sign-file <cafile>
10875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10876 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10877 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10878 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10879 'generate-certificates' for details.
10880
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010881ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010882 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10883 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10884 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10885 'generate-certificates' for details.
10886
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010887ciphers <ciphers>
10888 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10889 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010890 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3. The format of the
10891 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for
10892 instance a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without
10893 quotes). Depending on the compatibility and security requirements, the list
10894 of suitable ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background
10895 information and recommendations see e.g.
10896 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10897 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10898 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10899
10900ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10902 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10903 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10904 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
10905 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section, and can be for instance a
10906 string such as
10907 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
10908 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
10909 the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010910
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010911crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010912 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10913 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10914 to verify client's certificate.
10915
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010916crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010917 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10918 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10919 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10920 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10921 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10922 file.
10923
10924 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10925 are loaded.
10926
10927 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010928 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010929 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10930 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10931 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10932 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010933 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10934 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010935 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010936
10937 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10938 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10939 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10940 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010941 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10942 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010943
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010944 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010945
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010946 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010947 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010948 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10949 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010950 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10951 clients).
10952
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010953 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10954 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10955 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10956 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10957 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10958 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10959 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10960 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10961 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10962 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10963 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10964 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10965 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10966
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010967 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10968 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10969 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10970 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10971 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10972
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010973 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10974 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10975 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10976 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010977
10978 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10979 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10980 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10981 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10982 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10983 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10984 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10985 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10986 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10987
10988 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10989
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010990 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010991 a cert bundle.
10992
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010993 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010994 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10995 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10996 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10997 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10998 provide multi-cert support.
10999
11000 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11001
11002 Filename | CN | SAN
11003 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11004 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011005 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011006 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11007 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11008
11009 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11010 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11011 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11012 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011013 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11014 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11015 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011016
11017 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11018 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11019
11020 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11021 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11022 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11023
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011024crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011025 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011026 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011027 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011028 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011029
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011030crt-list <file>
11031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011032 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11033 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011034
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011035 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11036
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011037 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11038 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011039 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011040 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011041
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011042 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11043 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11044 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11045 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11046 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11047 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11048 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11049 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011050
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011051 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011052 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011053 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11054 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11055 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011056
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011057 crt-list file example:
11058 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011059 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011060 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011061 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011062
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011063defer-accept
11064 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11065 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11066 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011067 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011068 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11069 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11070 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11071 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11072 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11073 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11074 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11075
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011076expose-fd listeners
11077 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11078 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011079 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11080 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011081 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011082
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011083force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011084 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011085 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011086 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011087 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011088
11089force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011090 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011091 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011092 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011093
11094force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011095 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011096 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011097 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011098
11099force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011100 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011101 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011102 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011103
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011104force-tlsv13
11105 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11106 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011107 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011108
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011109generate-certificates
11110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11111 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11112 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11113 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11114 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11115 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11116 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11117 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11118 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11119 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11120 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11121
11122 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11123 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011124 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011125 certificate is used many times.
11126
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011127gid <gid>
11128 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11129 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11130 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11131 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11132 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11133
11134group <group>
11135 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11136 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11137 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11138 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11139 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11140
11141id <id>
11142 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11143 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11144 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11145 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11146
11147interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011148 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11149 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11150 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11151 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11152 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11153 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011154 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11155 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11156 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11157 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11158 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11159 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011160
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011161level <level>
11162 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11163 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11164 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011165 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011166 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11167 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11168 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011169 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011170 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011171 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011172 all counters).
11173
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011174severity-output <format>
11175 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11176 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11177 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11178 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11179 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11180 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11181 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11182 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11183 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11184 rfc5424 convention.
11185
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011186maxconn <maxconn>
11187 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11188 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11189 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11190 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11191 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11192 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11193 eat all memory.
11194
11195mode <mode>
11196 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11197 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11198 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11199 UNIX sockets.
11200
11201mss <maxseg>
11202 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11203 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11204 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11205 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11206 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11207 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11208 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11209 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11210 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11211 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11212 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11213
11214name <name>
11215 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11216 page.
11217
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011218namespace <name>
11219 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11220 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11221 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11222 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11223
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011224nice <nice>
11225 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11226 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11227 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11228 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11229 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11230 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11231 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11232 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11233 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11234 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11235 one for an RDP socket.
11236
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011237no-ca-names
11238 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11239 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11240
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011241no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011242 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011243 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011244 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011245 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011246 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11247 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011248
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011249no-tls-tickets
11250 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11251 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11252 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011253 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11254 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011255
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011256no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011257 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011258 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011259 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011260 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011261 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11262 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011263
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011264no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011266 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011267 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011268 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011269 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11270 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011271
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011272no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011273 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011274 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011275 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011276 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011277 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11278 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011279
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011280no-tlsv13
11281 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11282 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11283 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11284 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011285 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11286 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011287
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011288npn <protocols>
11289 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11290 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11291 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11292 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011293 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011294 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11295 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11296 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11297 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11298 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011299
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011300prefer-client-ciphers
11301 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11302 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11303 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011304 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11305 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11306 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011307
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011308process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
11309 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
11310 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011311 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011312 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11313 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11314 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11315 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011316 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011317 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
11318 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
11319 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
11320
11321 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11322
11323 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11324 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11325 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11326 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11327 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11328 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11329 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11330 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011331
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011332proto <name>
11333 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11334 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11335 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11336 in haproxy -vv.
11337 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11338 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011339 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011340 h2" on the bind line.
11341
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011342ssl
11343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011344 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011345 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11346 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011347 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11348 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011349
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011350ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11351 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11352 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11353 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11354
11355ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11356 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11357 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11358 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11359
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011360strict-sni
11361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11362 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11363 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11364 See the "crt" option for more information.
11365
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011366tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011367 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011368 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11369 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011370 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011371 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11372 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11373 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11374 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11375 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11376 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11377 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11378
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011379tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011380 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011381 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11382 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11383 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11384 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11385 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11386 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11387 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011388 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11389 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11390 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011391
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011392tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11393 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011394 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11395 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11396 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11397 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11398 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11399 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11400 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11401 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11402 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11403 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011404 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11405 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11406
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011407transparent
11408 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11409 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11410 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11411 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11412 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11413 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11414 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11415 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11416 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11417 so check for support with your vendor.
11418
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011419v4v6
11420 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11421 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11422 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11423 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011424 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011425
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011426v6only
11427 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11428 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11429 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011430 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11431 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011432
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011433uid <uid>
11434 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11435 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11436 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11437 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11438 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11439
11440user <user>
11441 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11442 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11443 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11444 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11445 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11446
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011447verify [none|optional|required]
11448 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11449 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11450 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11451 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11452 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011453 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11454 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11455 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11456 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011457
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114585.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011459------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011461The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11462which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11463arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11464settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11465after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11466Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11467address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011468
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011469 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011470 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011471
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011472Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11473keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011475The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011476
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011477addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011478 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011479 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11480 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11481 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11482 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11483 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011484
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011485agent-check
11486 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011487 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011488 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11489 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11490 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011491
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011492 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011493 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011494 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11495 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11496 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011497
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011498 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11499 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11500 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11501 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11502 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011503
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011504 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011505 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011506
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011507 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11508 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11509 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011510
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011511 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11512 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11513 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011514
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011515 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11516 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11517 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11518 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11519 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011520 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011521 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011522
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011523 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11524 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011525
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011526 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11527 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11528 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11529 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11530 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11531 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11532 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11533 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11534 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011535
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011536 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11537 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011538 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11539 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11540 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011541 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011542
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011543 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011544 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011545
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011546agent-send <string>
11547 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11548 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11549 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11550 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11551 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11552
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011553agent-inter <delay>
11554 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11555 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11556
11557 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11558 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11559 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11560 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11561 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11562 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11563 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11564 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11565 of backends use the same servers.
11566
11567 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11568
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011569agent-addr <addr>
11570 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11571
11572 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11573 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11574 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11575 hostname, it will be resolved.
11576
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011577agent-port <port>
11578 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11579
11580 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11581
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011582alpn <protocols>
11583 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11584 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11585 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11586 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11587 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11588 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11589 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11590 now obsolete NPN extension.
11591 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11592 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11593
11594 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011596backup
11597 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11598 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11599 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11600 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011601 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11602 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011603
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011604ca-file <cafile>
11605 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11606 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11607 server's certificate.
11608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011609check
11610 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011611 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11612 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11613 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11614 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11615 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11616 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11617 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011618 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11619 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011620 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11621 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011622
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011623check-send-proxy
11624 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11625 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11626 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11627 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11628 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11629 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11630 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11631
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011632check-alpn <protocols>
11633 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11634 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11635 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11636
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011637check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011638 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011639 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11640 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011641
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011642check-ssl
11643 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11644 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11645 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11646 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011647 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011648 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11649 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011650 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011651 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11652 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011653
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011654ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011655 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11656 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11657 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011658 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11659 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11660 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11661 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11662 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11663 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11664
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011665ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11666 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11667 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11668 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11669 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
11670 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section.
11671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011672cookie <value>
11673 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11674 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11675 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11676 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11677 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11678 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11679 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11680
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011681crl-file <crlfile>
11682 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11683 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11684 to verify server's certificate.
11685
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011686crt <cert>
11687 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11688 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11689 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11690 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11691 certificate request.
11692
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011693disabled
11694 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11695 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11696 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11697 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11698 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011699 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011700
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011701enabled
11702 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11703 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11704 default value.
11705 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11706 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011708error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011709 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11710 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11711 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011712
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011713 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011715fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011716 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11717 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11718 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11719
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011720force-sslv3
11721 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11722 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011723 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011724 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011725
11726force-tlsv10
11727 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011728 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011729 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011730
11731force-tlsv11
11732 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011733 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011734 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011735
11736force-tlsv12
11737 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011738 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011739 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011740
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011741force-tlsv13
11742 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11743 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011744 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011746id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011747 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11748 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11749 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011750
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011751init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11752 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11753 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011754 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011755 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11756 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11757 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11758 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11759 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11760 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11761 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11762 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11763 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011764 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011765 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11766 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11767 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11768 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11769 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11770 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011771 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011772
11773 Example:
11774 defaults
11775 # never fail on address resolution
11776 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11777
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011778inter <delay>
11779fastinter <delay>
11780downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011781 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11782 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11783 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11784 between checks depending on the server state :
11785
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011786 Server state | Interval used
11787 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11788 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11789 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11790 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11791 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11792 or yet unchecked. |
11793 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11794 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11795 | "inter" otherwise.
11796 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011798 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11799 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11800 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11801 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011802 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11803 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11804 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11805 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11806 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011808maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011809 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11810 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11811 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11812 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11813 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11814 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11815 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11816 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011818maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011819 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11820 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11821 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11822 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11823 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11824 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11825 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11826
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011827max-reuse <count>
11828 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11829 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11830 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11831 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11832 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11833 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11834 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11835 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11836
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011837minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011838 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11839 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11840 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11841 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11842 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11843 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011844 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011845 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011846
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011847namespace <name>
11848 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11849 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11850 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11851 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11852
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011853no-agent-check
11854 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11855 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11856 default value.
11857 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11858 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11859
11860no-backup
11861 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11862 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11863 default value.
11864 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11865 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11866
11867no-check
11868 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11869 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11870 default value.
11871 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11872 "default-server" "check" setting.
11873
11874no-check-ssl
11875 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11876 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11877 default value.
11878 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11879 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11880
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011881no-send-proxy
11882 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11883 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11884 default value.
11885 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11886 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11887
11888no-send-proxy-v2
11889 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11890 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11891 default value.
11892 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11893 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11894
11895no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11896 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11897 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11898 default value.
11899 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11900 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11901
11902no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11903 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11904 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11905 default value.
11906 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11907 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11908
11909no-ssl
11910 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11911 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11912 default value.
11913 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11914 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11915
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011916no-ssl-reuse
11917 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11918 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11919 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11920 and for paranoid users.
11921
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011922no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011923 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11924 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011925 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011926
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011927 Supported in default-server: No
11928
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011929no-tls-tickets
11930 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11931 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11932 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011933 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11934 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011935 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011936
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011937no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011938 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011939 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11940 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011941 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11942 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011943 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011944
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011945 Supported in default-server: No
11946
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011947no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011948 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011949 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11950 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011951 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11952 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011953 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011954
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011955 Supported in default-server: No
11956
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011957no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011958 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011959 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11960 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011961 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11962 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011963 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011964
11965 Supported in default-server: No
11966
11967no-tlsv13
11968 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11969 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11970 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11971 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11972 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011973 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011974
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011975 Supported in default-server: No
11976
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011977no-verifyhost
11978 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11979 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11980 default value.
11981 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11982 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011983
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011984non-stick
11985 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11986 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11987 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11988
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011989npn <protocols>
11990 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11991 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11992 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11993 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11994 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11995 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11996 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11997
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011998observe <mode>
11999 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12000 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12001 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12002 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12003 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12004 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012005 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012006
12007 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12008
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012009on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012010 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12011 Currently, four modes are available:
12012 - fastinter: force fastinter
12013 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12014 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12015 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12016 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12017
12018 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12019
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012020on-marked-down <action>
12021 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12022 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012023 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12024 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12025 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12026 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12027 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12028 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12029 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12030 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012031
12032 Actions are disabled by default
12033
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012034on-marked-up <action>
12035 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12036 Currently one action is available:
12037 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12038 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12039 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12040 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012041 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12042 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012043 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12044 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12045
12046 Actions are disabled by default
12047
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012048pool-max-conn <max>
12049 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12050 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12051 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12052 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12053 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12054 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12055
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012056pool-purge-delay <delay>
12057 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
12058 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means it's never purged. The default is
12059 1s.
12060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012061port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012062 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12063 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12064 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12065 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12066 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12067 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12068
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012069proto <name>
12070
12071 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12072 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12073 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12074 reported in haproxy -vv.
12075 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12076 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012078redir <prefix>
12079 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12080 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12081 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12082 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12083 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12084 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12085 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12086 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012087 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012088 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012089 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12090 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12091 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12092 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12093
12094 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012096rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012097 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12098 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12099 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12100
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012101resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12102 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12103 server.
12104
12105 Available options:
12106
12107 * allow-dup-ip
12108 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12109 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12110 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12111 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12112 For such case, simply enable this option.
12113 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12114
12115 * prevent-dup-ip
12116 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12117 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12118 same fqdn.
12119 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12120
12121 Example:
12122 backend b_myapp
12123 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12124 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12125 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12126
12127 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12128 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12129 it
12130 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12131 different address
12132
12133 Default value: not set
12134
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012135resolve-prefer <family>
12136 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12137 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12138 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12139 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12140
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012141 Default value: ipv6
12142
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012143 Example:
12144
12145 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012146
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012147resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12148 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12149 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012150 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012151 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12152 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012153 configured network, another address is selected.
12154
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012155 Example:
12156
12157 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012158
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012159resolvers <id>
12160 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12161 hostname.
12162
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012163 Example:
12164
12165 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012166
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012167 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012168
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012169send-proxy
12170 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12171 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12172 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12173 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012174 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12175 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12176 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12177 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12178 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12179 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12180 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12181 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12182 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12183 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012184 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12185 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012186
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012187send-proxy-v2
12188 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12189 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12190 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12191 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012192 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12193 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12194 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12195 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012196
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012197proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12198 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12199 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012200 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12201 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012202 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12203 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012204 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012205
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012206send-proxy-v2-ssl
12207 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12208 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12209 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12210 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12211 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12212 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12213 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012214 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12215 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012216
12217send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12218 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12219 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12220 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12221 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12222 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12223 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12224 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12225 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012226 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12227 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012228
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012229slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012230 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12231 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12232 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12233 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12234 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12235 parameters :
12236
12237 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12238 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12239
12240 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12241 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12242 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12243 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12244
12245 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12246 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12247 seen as failed.
12248
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012249sni <expression>
12250 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12251 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12252 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12253 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012254 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12255 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012256 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012257 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12258 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012259
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012260source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012261source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012262source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012263 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12264 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12265 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12266 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12267
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012268 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12269 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12270 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12271 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12272 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12273 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12274 server.
12275
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012276 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12277 specifying the source address without port(s).
12278
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012279ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012280 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12281 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12282 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12283 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12284 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12285 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012286 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12287 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012288
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012289ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12290 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12291 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12292 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12293
12294ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12295 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12296 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12297 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12298
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012299ssl-reuse
12300 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12301 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12302 default value.
12303 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12304 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12305
12306stick
12307 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12308 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12309 default value.
12310 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12311 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012312
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012313tcp-ut <delay>
12314 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12315 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12316 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012317 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012318 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12319 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12320 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12321 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12322 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12323 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12324 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12325 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12326 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012328track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012329 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12330 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12331 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12332 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012333 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12334
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012335tls-tickets
12336 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12337 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12338 default value.
12339 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12340 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012341
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012342verify [none|required]
12343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012344 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012345 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12346 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012347 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012348 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12349 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12350 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12351 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12352 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12353 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12354 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12355 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012356
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012357verifyhost <hostname>
12358 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012359 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12360 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12361 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12362 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12363 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12364 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12365 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12366 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012368weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012369 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12370 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12371 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012372 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12373 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12374 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12375 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12376 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12377 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012378
12379
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123805.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12381-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012382
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012383HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12384using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12385configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012386This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12387can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12388workload.
12389This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12390resolution at run time.
12391Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12392carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12393
12394
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123955.3.1. Global overview
12396----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012397
12398As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12399different steps of the process life:
12400
12401 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12402 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12403 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12404
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012405 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12406 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012407
12408A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12409 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12410 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12411 resolution to know this new IP.
12412
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012413When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012414HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012415SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12416from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12417will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12418will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012419
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012420A few things important to notice:
12421 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12422 first valid response.
12423
12424 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12425 servers return an error.
12426
12427
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124285.3.2. The resolvers section
12429----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012430
12431This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012432HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12433contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012434
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012435When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12436uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12437is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12438answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12439
12440When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012441used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012442
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012443 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12444 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12445 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012446
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012447 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12448 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012449
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012450 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12451 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12452 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012453
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012454For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12455following scenarios are possible:
12456
12457 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12458 ignored
12459
12460 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12461 applied
12462
12463 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12464 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12465
12466 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12467 retries the query with a new type
12468
12469 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12470 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012471
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012472As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12473a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012474<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012475
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012476
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012477resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012478 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012479
12480A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12481
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012482accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012483 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012484 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012485 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12486 by RFC 6891)
12487
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012488 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12489
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012490nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12491 DNS server description:
12492 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12493 <ip> : IP address of the server
12494 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12495
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012496parse-resolv-conf
12497 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12498 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12499 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12500
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012501hold <status> <period>
12502 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12503 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012504 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012505 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012506 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12507 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12508 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12509
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012510 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012511
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012512resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012513 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12514 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12515 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12516
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012517resolve_retries <nb>
12518 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12519 giving up.
12520 Default value: 3
12521
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012522 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12523 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12524 type.
12525
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012526timeout <event> <time>
12527 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12528 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12529 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012530 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12531 other time applied.
12532 Default value: 1s
12533 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12534 have been received.
12535 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012536 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12537 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12538
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012539 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012540
12541 resolvers mydns
12542 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12543 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012544 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012545 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012546 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012547 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012548 hold other 30s
12549 hold refused 30s
12550 hold nx 30s
12551 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012552 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012553 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012554
12555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125566. HTTP header manipulation
12557---------------------------
12558
12559In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12560response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12561request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12562which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012563against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012564
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012565If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12566to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12567but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12568HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12569stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12570because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12571a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12572still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012574This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12575in section 4.2 :
12576
12577 - reqadd <string>
12578 - reqallow <search>
12579 - reqiallow <search>
12580 - reqdel <search>
12581 - reqidel <search>
12582 - reqdeny <search>
12583 - reqideny <search>
12584 - reqpass <search>
12585 - reqipass <search>
12586 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12587 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12588 - reqtarpit <search>
12589 - reqitarpit <search>
12590 - rspadd <string>
12591 - rspdel <search>
12592 - rspidel <search>
12593 - rspdeny <search>
12594 - rspideny <search>
12595 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12596 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12597
12598With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12599is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12600parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12601prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12602Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12603
12604 \t for a tab
12605 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12606 \n for a new line (LF)
12607 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12608 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12609 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12610 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12611 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12612
12613The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12614portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12615above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12616regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
126179 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12618is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12619
12620The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12621after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12622
12623Notes related to these keywords :
12624---------------------------------
12625 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12626 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12627 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12628
12629 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12630 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12631 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12632
12633 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12634 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12635 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12636 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12637 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12638
12639 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12640 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12641 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12642 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12643 useless headers before adding new ones.
12644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012645 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012646 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12647
12648 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12649 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12650 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12651
12652 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12653 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012654 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012655
12656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126577. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12658----------------------------------
12659
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012660HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012661client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12662The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12663these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12664but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12665data called patterns.
12666
12667
126687.1. ACL basics
12669---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012670
12671The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12672content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12673from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12674simple :
12675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012676 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012677 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012678 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12679 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012681The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12682adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012683
12684In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012686 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012687
12688This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12689Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12690and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012691an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12692conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12693as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12694are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012695
12696ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12697'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12698which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12699
12700There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12701performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012703The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12704specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12705this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012706methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12707ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012708
12709Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12710 - boolean
12711 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12712 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12713 - string
12714 - data block
12715
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012716Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12717converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12718would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12719The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12720which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12721
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012722Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12723keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12724fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12725which are summarized in the table below :
12726
12727 +---------------------+-----------------+
12728 | Sample or converter | Default |
12729 | output type | matching method |
12730 +---------------------+-----------------+
12731 | boolean | bool |
12732 +---------------------+-----------------+
12733 | integer | int |
12734 +---------------------+-----------------+
12735 | ip | ip |
12736 +---------------------+-----------------+
12737 | string | str |
12738 +---------------------+-----------------+
12739 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12740 +---------------------+-----------------+
12741
12742Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12743matching method, see below.
12744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012745The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12746 - boolean
12747 - integer or integer range
12748 - IP address / network
12749 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12750 - regular expression
12751 - hex block
12752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012753The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12754
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012755 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12756 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012757 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012758 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012759 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012760 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012761 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012763The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12764read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12765if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12766lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12767will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12768beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12769a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12770lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12771exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12772
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012773The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12774parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12775ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12776a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12777check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12778
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012779The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12780socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12781file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012783Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12784loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12785
12786 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12787
12788In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12789the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12790case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12791as well.
12792
12793The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12794sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12795do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12796methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12797is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012798obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012799followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12800default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12801that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12802string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12803
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012804The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12805By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12806string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12807resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12808server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12809waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12810flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12811function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012813There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12814sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12815be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012816
12817 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12818 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012819 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12820 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12821 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12822 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012823
12824 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12825 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012826 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012827
12828 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012829 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012830
12831 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012832 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012833
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012834 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012835 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12836
12837 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12838 binary or string samples.
12839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012840 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12841 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012843 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12844 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12845 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012847 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12848 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012850 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12851 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012853 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12854 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012856 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12857 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012858 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012860 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12861 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12862 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012863
12864For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12865request, it is possible to do :
12866
12867 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12868
12869In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12870buffer, one would use the following acl :
12871
12872 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12873
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012874On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12875possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12876
12877 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012879All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12880criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12881method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12882to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12883criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12884the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012886If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012887the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12888For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012890 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12891 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12892 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12893 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012894
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012895
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012896The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12897types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12898combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12899brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12900default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012902 +-------------------------------------------------+
12903 | Input sample type |
12904 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012905 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012906 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12907 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12908 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012909 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012910 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012911 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012912 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012913 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012914 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012915 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012916 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012917 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012918 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012919 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012920 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012921 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012922 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012923 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012924 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012925 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012926 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012927 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012928 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012929 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012930 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12931 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12932 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012933
12934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129357.1.1. Matching booleans
12936------------------------
12937
12938In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12939Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12940When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12941that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12942
12943Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12944return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12945"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12946
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129487.1.2. Matching integers
12949------------------------
12950
12951Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12952enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12953to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12954
12955Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12956matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12957lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012958
12959For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12960unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12961representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12962
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012963As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12964two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12965instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12966ranges and operators.
12967
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012968For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012969operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12970Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12971of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012973Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012974
12975 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12976 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12977 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12978 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12979 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12980
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012981For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012982
12983 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12984
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012985This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12986
12987 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12988
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129907.1.3. Matching strings
12991-----------------------
12992
12993String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12994different forms :
12995
12996 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012997 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012998
12999 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013000 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013001
13002 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13003 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13004
13005 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13006 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13007
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013008 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013009 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13010 matches.
13011
13012 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13013 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13014 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013015
13016String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13017exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13018characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13019string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13020to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013021before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013022
13023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130247.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13025---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013026
13027Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13028they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13029possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13030passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13031the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013032the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13033match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013034
13035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130367.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13037-------------------------------------
13038
13039It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13040not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13041a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13042to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13043digits may be used upper or lower case.
13044
13045Example :
13046 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13047 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13048
13049
130507.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13051---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013052
13053IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13054netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13055within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013056host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013057difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13058at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13059does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13060parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013061
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013062The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13063abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13064
13065 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13066 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13067 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13068 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13069 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13070 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13071 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13072 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13073
13074Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13075192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13076
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013077IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13078Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13079trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13080IPv6 patterns.
13081
13082HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13083following situations :
13084 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13085 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13086 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13087 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13088 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13089 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13090 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13091 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13092 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13093 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013095
130967.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13097----------------------------------
13098
13099Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13100combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13101
13102 - AND (implicit)
13103 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13104 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013106A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013108 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013110Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13111indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013113For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13114"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13115requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13116is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13117
13118 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013119 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13120 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13121 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013122
13123To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13124and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13125
13126 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13127 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13128 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13129 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13130
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013131 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013132 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13133 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13134 use_backend www if host_www
13135
13136It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13137expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13138be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13139the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13140
13141 The following rule :
13142
13143 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013144 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013145
13146 Can also be written that way :
13147
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013148 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013149
13150It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13151to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13152simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13153sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13154good use is the following :
13155
13156 With named ACLs :
13157
13158 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13159 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13160 monitor fail if site_dead
13161
13162 With anonymous ACLs :
13163
13164 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13165
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013166See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13167keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013168
13169
131707.3. Fetching samples
13171---------------------
13172
13173Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13174against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13175sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13176ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13177of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13178available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13179
13180This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13181Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13182compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13183deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13184
13185The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13186matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13187method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13188indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13189
13190As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13191when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13192mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13193the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13194ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13195
13196Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13197multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13198when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013199incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13200are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013201is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13202all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13203
13204Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13205 - name
13206 - name(arg1)
13207 - name(arg1,arg2)
13208
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013209
132107.3.1. Converters
13211-----------------
13212
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013213Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13214of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13215is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13216was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013217has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013218unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13219
13220These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13221sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13222the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013223support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013224
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013225A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13226support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13227supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13228(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13229bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013231The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013232
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001323351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13234 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13235 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13236 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13237 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13238 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13239
13240 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013241 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13242 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013243 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13244 frontend http-in
13245 bind *:8081
13246 default_backend servers
13247 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13248 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13249
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013250add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013251 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013252 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013253 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13254 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013255 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013256 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13257 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13258 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13259 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013260 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013261 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013262
13263and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013264 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013265 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013266 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13267 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013268 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013269 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13270 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13271 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13272 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013273 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013274 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013275
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013276b64dec
13277 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13278 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13279
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013280base64
13281 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013282 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013283 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13284
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013285bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013286 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013287 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013288 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013289 presence of a flag).
13290
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013291bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13292 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13293 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013294 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013295
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013296concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13297 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13298 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13299 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13300 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13301 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13302 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13303 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13304 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13305 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13306 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13307 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13308 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13309 delimitors.
13310
13311 Example:
13312 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13313 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13314 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13315 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13316
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013317cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013318 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13319 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013320
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013321crc32([<avalanche>])
13322 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13323 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13324 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13325 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13326 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13327 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13328 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13329 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13330 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13331 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013332 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13333
13334crc32c([<avalanche>])
13335 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13336 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13337 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13338 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13339 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13340 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13341 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13342 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013343
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013344da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013345 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13346 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13347 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13348 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013349 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013350 configuration language.
13351
13352 Example:
13353 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013354 bind *:8881
13355 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013356 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013357
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013358debug
13359 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13360 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13361 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13362
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013363div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013364 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13365 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013366 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013367 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13368 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013369 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013370 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13371 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13372 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13373 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013374 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013375 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013376
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013377djb2([<avalanche>])
13378 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13379 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13380 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13381 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13382 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13383 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13384 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013385 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13386 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013387
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013388even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013389 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013390 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13391
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013392field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13393 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13394 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13395 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13396 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13397 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13398 fields.
13399
13400 Example :
13401 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13402 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13403 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13404 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13405 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013406
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013407hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013408 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013409 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013410 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013411 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013412
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013413hex2i
13414 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13415 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13416
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013417http_date([<offset>])
13418 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13419 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13420 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13421 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13422 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13423 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013424
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013425in_table(<table>)
13426 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13427 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13428 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013429 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013430 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13431
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013432ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13433 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013434 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013435 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13436 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13437 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13438 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13439 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013440
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013441json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013442 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013443 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013444 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013445 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13446 of errors:
13447 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13448 bytes, ...)
13449 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13450 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13451
13452 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13453 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13454 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13455 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13456 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13457 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013458 - "ascii" : never fails;
13459 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13460 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013461 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013462 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013463 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13464 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13465
13466 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013467 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013468
13469 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013470 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013471 capture request header user-agent len 150
13472 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013473
13474 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13475 GET / HTTP/1.0
13476 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13477
13478 Output log:
13479 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13480
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013481language(<value>[,<default>])
13482 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13483 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13484 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13485 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13486 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13487 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13488 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13489 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13490 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013491 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013492 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13493 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013494
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013495 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013496
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013497 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13498 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013499
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013500 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13501 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13502 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13503 use_backend spanish if es
13504 use_backend french if fr
13505 use_backend english if en
13506 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013507
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013508length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013509 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13510 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13511 type. The result is of type integer.
13512
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013513lower
13514 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13515 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13516 type. The result is of type string.
13517
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013518ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13519 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13520 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13521 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13522 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13523 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13524 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13525
13526 Example :
13527
13528 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013529 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013530 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13531
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013532map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13533map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13534map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13535 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13536 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13537 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13538 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13539 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13540 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13541 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13542 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013543
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013544 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13545 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13546 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013547
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013548 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013549 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013550
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013551 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13552 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13553 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13554 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013555 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13556 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013557 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13558 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13559 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13560 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13561 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13562 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13563 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13564 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013565 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13566 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13567 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013568 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13569 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13570 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13571 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13572 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013573
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013574 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13575 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13576 the corresponding match text.
13577
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013578 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13579 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13580 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13581 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13582 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013583
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013584 Example :
13585
13586 # this is a comment and is ignored
13587 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13588 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13589 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13590 | | | `---------- value
13591 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13592 | `---------------------------- key
13593 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13594
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013595mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013596 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13597 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013598 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013599 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013600 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013601 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13602 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13603 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13604 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013605 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013606 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013607
13608mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013609 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013610 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13611 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013612 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013613 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013614 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013615 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13616 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13617 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13618 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013619 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013620 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013621
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013622nbsrv
13623 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13624 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13625 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13626 map lookup.
13627
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013628neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013629 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13630 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13631 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13632 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013633
13634not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013635 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013636 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013637 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013638 absence of a flag).
13639
13640odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013641 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013642 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13643
13644or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013645 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013646 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013647 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13648 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013649 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013650 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13651 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13652 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13653 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013654 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013655 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013656
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013657regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013658 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13659 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13660 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13661 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13662 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13663 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13664 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13665 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13666 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13667 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013668 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13669 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13670 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13671 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013672
13673 Example :
13674
13675 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13676 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13677 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13678 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13679
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013680capture-req(<id>)
13681 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13682 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13683
13684 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013685 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13686 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013687
13688capture-res(<id>)
13689 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13690 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13691
13692 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013693 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13694 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013695
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013696sdbm([<avalanche>])
13697 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13698 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13699 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13700 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13701 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13702 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13703 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013704 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13705 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013706
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013707set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013708 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13709 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13710 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013711 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013712 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13713 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013714 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013715 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13716 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013717 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013718 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013719
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013720sha1
13721 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13722 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13723
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013724strcmp(<var>)
13725 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13726 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13727 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13728 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13729 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13730 shorter).
13731
13732 Example :
13733
13734 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13735 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13736 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13737
13738
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013739sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013740 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13741 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013742 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013743 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13744 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013745 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013746 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13747 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013748 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013749 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13750 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013751 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013752 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013753
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013754table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13755 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13756 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13757 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13758 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13759 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13760 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13761
13762
13763table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13764 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13765 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13766 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13767 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13768 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13769 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13770
13771table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13772 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13773 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013774 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013775 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13776 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13777
13778table_conn_cur(<table>)
13779 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13780 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13781 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13782 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13783 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13784
13785table_conn_rate(<table>)
13786 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13787 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13788 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13789 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13790 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13791
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013792table_gpt0(<table>)
13793 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13794 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13795 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13796 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13797 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13798
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013799table_gpc0(<table>)
13800 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13801 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13802 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13803 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13804 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13805
13806table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13807 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13808 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13809 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13810 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13811 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13812 sample fetch keyword.
13813
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013814table_gpc1(<table>)
13815 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13816 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13817 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13818 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13819 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13820
13821table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13822 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13823 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13824 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13825 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13826 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13827 sample fetch keyword.
13828
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013829table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13830 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13831 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013832 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013833 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13834 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13835
13836table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13837 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13838 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13839 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13840 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13841 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13842 keyword.
13843
13844table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13845 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13846 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013847 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013848 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13849 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13850
13851table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13852 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13853 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13854 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13855 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13856 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13857 keyword.
13858
13859table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13860 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13861 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013862 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013863 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13864 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13865 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13866 keyword.
13867
13868table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13869 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13870 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013871 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013872 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13873 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13874 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13875 keyword.
13876
13877table_server_id(<table>)
13878 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13879 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13880 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13881 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13882 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13883 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13884
13885table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13886 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13887 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013888 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013889 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13890 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13891 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13892 keyword.
13893
13894table_sess_rate(<table>)
13895 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13896 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13897 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13898 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13899 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13900 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13901 keyword.
13902
13903table_trackers(<table>)
13904 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13905 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13906 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13907 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13908 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13909 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13910 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13911 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13912 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13913 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13914
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013915upper
13916 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13917 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13918 type. The result is of type string.
13919
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013920url_dec
13921 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13922 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13923
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013924unset-var(<var name>)
13925 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13926 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13927 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13928 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13929 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13930 response),
13931 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13932 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13933 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13934 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13935
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013936utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13937 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13938 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13939 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13940 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13941 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13942 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13943
13944 Example :
13945
13946 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013947 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013948 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13949
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013950word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13951 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13952 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13953 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13954 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13955 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13956
13957 Example :
13958 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13959 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13960 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13961 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13962 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013963
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013964wt6([<avalanche>])
13965 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13966 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13967 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13968 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13969 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13970 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13971 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013972 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13973 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013974
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013975xor(<value>)
13976 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013977 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013978 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013979 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013980 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013981 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13982 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013983 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013984 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13985 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013986 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013987 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013988
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013989xxh32([<seed>])
13990 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13991 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13992 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13993 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13994 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13995 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13996 as cryptographically secure.
13997
13998xxh64([<seed>])
13999 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14000 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14001 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14002 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14003 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14004 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14005 as cryptographically secure.
14006
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014007
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140087.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014009--------------------------------------------
14010
14011A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14012not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14013"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14014The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14015
14016always_false : boolean
14017 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14018 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14019
14020always_true : boolean
14021 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14022 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14023
14024avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014025 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014026 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14027 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14028 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14029 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14030 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14031 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14032 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14033 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14034 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14035 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14036 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14037 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14038 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014040be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014041 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14042 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14043 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14044 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014045 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14046
14047be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14048 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14049 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14050 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14051 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14052 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014053 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14054 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014055
14056 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14057 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14058 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014060be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14061 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14062 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14063 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014064 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014065 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14066 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014067
14068 Example :
14069 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14070 backend dynamic
14071 mode http
14072 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14073 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014074
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014075bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014076 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14077 of the string.
14078
14079bool(<bool>) : bool
14080 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14081 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014083connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14084 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014085 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014086 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14087 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014088
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014089 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014090 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014091 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14092
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014093 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14094 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014095
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014096 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014097 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014098 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014099 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014100 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014101 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014102 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014103
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014104 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14105 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014106 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014107 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014108
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014109cpu_calls : integer
14110 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14111 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14112 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14113 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14114 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14115 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14116
14117cpu_ns_avg : integer
14118 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14119 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14120 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14121 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14122 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14123 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14124 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14125 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14126 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14127 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14128 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14129
14130cpu_ns_tot : integer
14131 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14132 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14133 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14134 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14135 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14136 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14137 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14138 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14139 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14140 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14141 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14142 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14143 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14144
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014145date([<offset>]) : integer
14146 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14147 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14148 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14149 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014150 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14151
14152 Example :
14153
14154 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14155 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014156
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014157date_us : integer
14158 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14159 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14160 from the same timeval structure.
14161
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014162distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14163 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14164 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14165 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14166 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14167 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14168 list of supported tokens.
14169
14170distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14171 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14172 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14173 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14174 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14175 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14176 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14177 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14178 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14179 supported tokens.
14180
14181 Example :
14182 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14183 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14184 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14185 # send large files to the big farm
14186 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14187
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014188env(<name>) : string
14189 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14190 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14191 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14192 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14193 certain way.
14194
14195 Examples :
14196 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14197 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14198
14199 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14200 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014202fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14203 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014204 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14205 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014206 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14207 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014208 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014209 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14210 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014211
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014212fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14213 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14214 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14215 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014217fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14218 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14219 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14220 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14221 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14222 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14223 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14224 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14225 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014226
14227 Example :
14228 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14229 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14230 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14231 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14232 frontend mail
14233 bind :25
14234 mode tcp
14235 maxconn 100
14236 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14237 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14238 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14239 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014240
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014241hostname : string
14242 Returns the system hostname.
14243
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014244int(<integer>) : signed integer
14245 Returns a signed integer.
14246
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014247ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14248 Returns an ipv4.
14249
14250ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14251 Returns an ipv6.
14252
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014253lat_ns_avg : integer
14254 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14255 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14256 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14257 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14258 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14259 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14260 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14261 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14262 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14263 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14264 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14265 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14266 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14267 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14268
14269lat_ns_tot : integer
14270 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14271 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14272 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14273 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14274 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14275 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14276 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14277 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14278 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14279 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14280 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14281 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14282 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14283 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14284 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14285 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14286 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14287 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14288 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14289
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014290meth(<method>) : method
14291 Returns a method.
14292
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014293nbproc : integer
14294 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14295 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14296 and debugging purposes.
14297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014298nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14299 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14300 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14301 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014302 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14303 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14304 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014305
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014306prio_class : integer
14307 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14308 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14309 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14310
14311prio_offset : integer
14312 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14313 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14314 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14315 set-priority-offset".
14316
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014317proc : integer
14318 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14319 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14320 debugging purposes.
14321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014322queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014323 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14324 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14325 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014326 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14327 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14328 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14329 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14330 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14331
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014332rand([<range>]) : integer
14333 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14334 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14335 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14336 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14337 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014339srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14340 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14341 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14342 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14343 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14344 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014345 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14346 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14347
14348srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14349 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14350 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14351 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14352 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14353 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14354 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14355 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14356
14357 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14358 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014359
14360srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14361 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14362 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14363 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014364 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014365 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14366 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14367 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14368
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014369srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14370 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14371 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14372 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14373 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14374 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14375 fetch methods.
14376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14378 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14379 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014380 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014381 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14382 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014383 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014384 overloading servers).
14385
14386 Example :
14387 # Redirect to a separate back
14388 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14389 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14390 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14391
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014392stopping : boolean
14393 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14394 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14395 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14396
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014397str(<string>) : string
14398 Returns a string.
14399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014400table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14401 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14402 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14403
14404table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14405 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14406 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14407 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14408
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014409thread : integer
14410 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14411 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14412 and debugging purposes.
14413
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014414var(<var-name>) : undefined
14415 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014416 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14417 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014418 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014419 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14420 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014421 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014422 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14423 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014424 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014425 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014426
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144277.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014428----------------------------------
14429
14430The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14431closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14432methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14433sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14434TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014435the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14436counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014437"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14438used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14439can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14440Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14441table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14442tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14443currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014444
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014445bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014446 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14447 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14448 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014450be_id : integer
14451 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14452 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14453
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014454be_name : string
14455 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14456 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014458dst : ip
14459 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14460 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14461 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14462 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014463 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14464 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14465 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14466 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14467 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14468 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014469
14470dst_conn : integer
14471 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14472 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14473 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14474 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14475 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14476 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14477 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14478 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014479
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014480dst_is_local : boolean
14481 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14482 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14483 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14484 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014485 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014486 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14487 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14488 it only once per connection.
14489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014490dst_port : integer
14491 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14492 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14493 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14494 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14495 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14496 an HTTP header.
14497
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014498fc_http_major : integer
14499 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14500 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14501 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14502
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014503fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14504 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14505 header.
14506
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014507fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14508 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14509 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14510 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14511 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14512 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14513 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14514
14515fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14516 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14517 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14518 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14519 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14520 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14521 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14522
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014523fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14524 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14525 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14526 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14527 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14528
14529fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14530 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14531 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14532 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14533 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14534
14535fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14536 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14537 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14538 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14539 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14540
14541fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14542 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14543 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14544 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14545 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14546
14547fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14548 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14549 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14550 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14551 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14552
14553fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14554 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14555 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14556 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14557 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14558
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014559fe_defbe : string
14560 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14561 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014563fe_id : integer
14564 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014565 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014566 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14567
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014568fe_name : string
14569 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14570 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14571 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14572
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014573sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014574sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14575sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14576sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014577 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14578 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14579 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14580
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014581sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014582sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14583sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14584sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014585 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14586 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14587 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14588
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014589sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014590sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14591sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14592sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014593 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14594 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014595 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14596 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14597 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014598
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014599 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014600 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14601 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014602 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14603 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14604 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014605 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14606 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14607
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014608sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14609sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14610sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14611sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14612 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14613 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14614 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14615 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14616 when a first ACL was verified.
14617
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014618sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014619sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14620sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14621sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014622 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014623 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14624
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014625sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014626sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14627sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14628sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014629 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14630 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14631 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14632
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014633sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014634sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14635sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14636sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014637 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14638 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14639 See also src_conn_rate.
14640
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014641sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014642sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14643sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14644sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014645 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014646 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014647
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014648sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14649sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14650sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14651sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14652 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14653 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14654
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014655sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14656sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14657sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14658sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14659 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14660 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14661
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014662sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014663sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14664sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14665sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014666 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14667 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14668 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014669 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14670 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14671 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014672
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014673sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14674sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14675sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14676sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14677 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14678 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14679 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14680 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14681 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14682 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14683
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014684sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014685sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14686sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14687sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014688 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014689 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14690 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14691
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014692sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014693sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14694sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14695sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014696 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14697 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14698 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14699 src_http_err_rate.
14700
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014701sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014702sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14703sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14704sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014705 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014706 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14707 src_http_req_cnt.
14708
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014709sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014710sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14711sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14712sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014713 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14714 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14715 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14716 src_http_req_rate.
14717
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014718sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014719sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14720sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14721sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014722 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014723 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14724 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14725 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14726 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014727
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014728 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014729 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14730 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014731 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14732
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014733sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14734sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14735sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14736sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14737 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14738 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14739 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14740 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14741 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14742
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014743sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014744sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14745sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14746sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014747 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14748 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14749 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014750
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014751sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014752sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14753sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14754sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014755 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14756 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14757 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014758
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014759sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014760sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14761sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14762sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014763 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014764 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14765 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14766 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014767 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014768 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14769
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014770sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014771sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14772sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14773sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014774 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14775 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14776 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14777 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14778 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014779 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014780
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014781sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014782sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14783sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14784sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014785 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14786 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14787 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14788
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014789sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014790sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14791sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14792sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014793 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14794 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014795 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014796 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14797 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14799 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14800 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014802so_id : integer
14803 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14804 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14805 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014808 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014809 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14810 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14811 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014812 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14813 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14814 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014815 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14816 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14817 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14818 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14819 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14820 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14821 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014822
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014823 Example:
14824 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14825 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014827src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14828 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14829 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14830 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014831 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014833src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14834 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14835 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014836 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014837 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014839src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14840 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14841 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14842 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14843 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14844 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14845 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014846
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014847 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014848 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14849 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14850 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14851 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014852 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014853 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14854 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14855
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014856src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14857 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14858 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14859 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14860 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14861 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14862 was verified.
14863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014864src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014865 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014867 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014868 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014870src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014871 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014872 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14873 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014874 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014876src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14877 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14878 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14879 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014880 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014883 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014884 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014885 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014886 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014887
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014888src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14889 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14890 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14891 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14892 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14893
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014894src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14895 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14896 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14897 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14898 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014901 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014902 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014903 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14904 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014905 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14906 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14907 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014908
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014909src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14910 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14911 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14912 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14913 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14914 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14915 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14916 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014918src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014919 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014921 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014922 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014923 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014925src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14926 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14927 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14928 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14929 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014930 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014932src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014933 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014934 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14935 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014936 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014938src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14939 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14940 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14941 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014942 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014943 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014945src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14946 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14947 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14948 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014949 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14951 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014952
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014953 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014954 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014955 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014956 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014957
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014958src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14959 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14960 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14961 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14962 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14963 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14964 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14965
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014966src_is_local : boolean
14967 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14968 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14969 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14970 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014971 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014972 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14973 once per connection.
14974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014975src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014976 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14977 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14978 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14979 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14980 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014982src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014983 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14984 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14985 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14986 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14987 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014989src_port : integer
14990 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14991 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14992 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14993 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014995src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014996 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014997 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14998 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14999 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015000 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015002src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15003 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15004 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15005 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15006 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015007 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015009src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15010 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15011 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15012 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15013 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15014 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15015 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15016 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15017 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015018
15019 Example :
15020 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15021 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15022 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15023 listen ssh
15024 bind :22
15025 mode tcp
15026 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015027 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015028 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015029 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015031srv_id : integer
15032 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15033 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15034 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015035
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150367.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015037----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015039The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15040closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15041when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15042usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015043future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015044
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001504551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15046 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15047 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15048 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15049 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15050 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15051
15052 Example :
15053 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15054 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15055 # the request.
15056 frontend http-in
15057 bind *:8081
15058 default_backend servers
15059 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15060 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15061
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015062ssl_bc : boolean
15063 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15064 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15065 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15066
15067ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15068 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15069 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15070
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015071ssl_bc_alpn : string
15072 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15073 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15074 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15075 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15076 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15077 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15078 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15079 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15080 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15081
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015082ssl_bc_cipher : string
15083 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15084 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15085
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015086ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15087 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15088 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15089 session or a TLS ticket.
15090
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015091ssl_bc_npn : string
15092 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15093 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15094 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15095 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15096 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15097 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15098 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15099 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15100
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015101ssl_bc_protocol : string
15102 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15103 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15104
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015105ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015106 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015107 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15108 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015109
15110ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15111 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15112 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15113 if session was reused or not.
15114
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015115ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15116 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15117 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15118 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15119 BoringSSL.
15120
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015121ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15122 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15123 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015125ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15126 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15127 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15128 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15129 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15130 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15133 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15134 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15135 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15136 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015137
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015138ssl_c_der : binary
15139 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15140 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15141 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015143ssl_c_err : integer
15144 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15145 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15146 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15147 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15148 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015150ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15151 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15152 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15153 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15154 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15155 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15156 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15157 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15158 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015160ssl_c_key_alg : string
15161 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15162 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15163 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015165ssl_c_notafter : string
15166 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15167 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15168 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015170ssl_c_notbefore : string
15171 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15172 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15173 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015175ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15176 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15177 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15178 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15179 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15180 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15181 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15182 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15183 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015185ssl_c_serial : binary
15186 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15187 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15188 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015190ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15191 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15192 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15193 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015194 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15195 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15196
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015197 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015198 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15201 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15202 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15203 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015205ssl_c_used : boolean
15206 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15207 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015209ssl_c_verify : integer
15210 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15211 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15212 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15213 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015215ssl_c_version : integer
15216 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15217 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015218
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015219ssl_f_der : binary
15220 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15221 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15222 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015224ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15225 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15226 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15227 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15228 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015229 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015230 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15231 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15232 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015234ssl_f_key_alg : string
15235 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15236 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15237 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015239ssl_f_notafter : string
15240 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15241 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15242 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015244ssl_f_notbefore : string
15245 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15246 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15247 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015249ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15250 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15251 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15252 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15253 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15254 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15255 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15256 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15257 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015259ssl_f_serial : binary
15260 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15261 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15262 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015263
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015264ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15265 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15266 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15267 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015269ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15270 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15271 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15272 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015274ssl_f_version : integer
15275 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15276 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15277
15278ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015279 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15280 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15281 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015283 Example :
15284 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15285 listen http-https
15286 bind :80
15287 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15288 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15289
15290ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15291 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15292 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15293
15294ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015295 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015296 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15297 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15298 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15299 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15300 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15301 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15302 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15303 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015305ssl_fc_cipher : string
15306 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15307 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015308
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015309ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15310 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15311 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015312 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015313
15314ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15315 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15316 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015317 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015318
15319ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15320 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15321 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15322 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015323 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015324 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015325
15326ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15327 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15328 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015329 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015331ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015332 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15333 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015334 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15335 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15336 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15337 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015338
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015339ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15340 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15341 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15342 wait until the handshake happened.
15343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015344ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15345 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015346 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15347 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15348 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15349 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015350
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015351ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015352 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015353 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15354 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015356ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015357 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015358 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15359 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15360 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15361 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15362 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15363 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15364 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015366ssl_fc_protocol : string
15367 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15368 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015369
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015370ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015371 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015372 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15373 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015375ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15376 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15377 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15378 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15379 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015380
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015381ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15382 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15383 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15384 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15385 BoringSSL.
15386
15387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015388ssl_fc_sni : string
15389 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15390 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15391 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15392 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15393 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15394
15395 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15396 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15397 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015398 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15399 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015401 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015402 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15403 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015405ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15406 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15407 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015408
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015409
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154107.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015411------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015413Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15414sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15415only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15416For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15417be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15418can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15419sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15420for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15421content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015423payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015424 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15426 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015428payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15429 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015430 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015432
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015433req.hdrs : string
15434 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15435 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15436 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15437 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15438
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015439req.hdrs_bin : binary
15440 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15441 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15442 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15443 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15444 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15445 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15446
15447 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15448
15449 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15450 str: <int:length><bytes>
15451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015452req.len : integer
15453req_len : integer (deprecated)
15454 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15455 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15456 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15457 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15458 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15459 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15460 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15461 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015463req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15464 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015465 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15466 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15467 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15468 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015470 ACL alternatives :
15471 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15474 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15475 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15476 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15477 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479 ACL alternatives :
15480 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484req.proto_http : boolean
15485req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15486 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15487 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15488 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15489 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15490 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15491 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15492 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015494 Example:
15495 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15496 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15497 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015498 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015500req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15501rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15502 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15503 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15504 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15505 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15506 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15507 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15508 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015510 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15511 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15512 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15513 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15514 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15515 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015517 ACL derivatives :
15518 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520 Example :
15521 listen tse-farm
15522 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15523 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15524 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15525 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15526 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15527 persist rdp-cookie
15528 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15529 # This is only useful makes sense if
15530 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15531 stick-table type string size 204800
15532 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15533 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15534 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015536 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15537 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015539req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15540rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15541 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15542 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15543 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15544 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546 ACL derivatives :
15547 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015548
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015549req.ssl_alpn : string
15550 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15551 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15552 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15553 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15554 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15555 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015556 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015557
15558 Examples :
15559 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15560 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15561 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015562 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015563 default_backend bk_default
15564
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015565req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15566 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15567 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015568 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15569 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15570 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15571 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15572 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015574req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15575req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15576 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15577 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15578 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15579 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15580 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15581 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15582 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015584req.ssl_sni : string
15585req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15586 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15587 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15588 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15589 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15590 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15591 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15592 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15593 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15594 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15595 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15596 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15597 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599 ACL derivatives :
15600 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015602 Examples :
15603 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15604 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15605 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15606 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15607 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015608
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015609req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15610 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15611 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15612 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15613 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15614 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15615 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15616 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15617 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15618 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620req.ssl_ver : integer
15621req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15622 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15623 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15624 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15625 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15626 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15627 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15628 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015629 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015632 ACL derivatives :
15633 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015634
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015635res.len : integer
15636 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15637 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15638 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15639 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15640 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15641 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15642 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15643 content inspection.
15644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15646 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015647 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15648 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15649 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15650 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15653 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15654 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15655 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15656 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015658 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015659
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015660res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15661rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15662 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15663 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15664 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15665 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15666 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15667 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15668 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670wait_end : boolean
15671 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15672 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015673 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015674 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15675 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015676 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15678 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680 Examples :
15681 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15682 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15683 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015685 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15686 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15687 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15688 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15689 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15690 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15691 tcp-request content reject
15692
15693
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156947.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695--------------------------------------
15696
15697It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15698This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15699data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15700its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15701HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15702content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15703to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15704more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15705response are indexed.
15706
15707base : string
15708 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15709 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15710 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15711 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15712 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15713 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15714 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15715 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15716
15717 ACL derivatives :
15718 base : exact string match
15719 base_beg : prefix match
15720 base_dir : subdir match
15721 base_dom : domain match
15722 base_end : suffix match
15723 base_len : length match
15724 base_reg : regex match
15725 base_sub : substring match
15726
15727base32 : integer
15728 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15729 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15730 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015731 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15732 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15733 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734
15735base32+src : binary
15736 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15737 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15738 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15739 per-URL counters.
15740
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015741capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15742 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15743 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15744 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15745
15746capture.req.method : string
15747 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15748 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15749 because it's allocated.
15750
15751capture.req.uri : string
15752 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15753 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15754 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15755 allocated.
15756
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015757capture.req.ver : string
15758 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15759 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15760 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15761
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015762capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15763 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15764 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15765 The first entry is an index of 0.
15766 See also: "capture response header"
15767
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015768capture.res.ver : string
15769 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15770 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15771 persistent flag.
15772
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015773req.body : binary
15774 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15775 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15776 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15777 the first chunk is analyzed.
15778
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015779req.body_param([<name>) : string
15780 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15781 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15782 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15783 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15784 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15785 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15786 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15787 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15788 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15789 given.
15790
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015791req.body_len : integer
15792 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15793 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15794 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15795 "option http-buffer-request".
15796
15797req.body_size : integer
15798 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15799 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15800 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15801 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15802 "option http-buffer-request".
15803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804req.cook([<name>]) : string
15805cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15806 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15807 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15808 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15809 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15810 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15811 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15812 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15813 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15814
15815 ACL derivatives :
15816 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15817 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15818 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15819 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15820 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15821 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15822 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15823 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015825req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15826cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15827 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15828 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015830req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15831cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15832 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15833 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15834 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15835 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015837cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15838 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15839 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15840 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15841 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015842 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015843 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15844 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15845 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15846 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015848hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15849 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15850 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15851 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15852 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015853 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015855req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15856 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15857 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15858 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15859 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15860 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15861 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15862 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15863 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015865req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15866 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15867 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15868 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15869 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15872 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15873 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15874 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15875 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15876 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15877 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15878 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15879 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015880 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015882 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015884 ACL derivatives :
15885 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15886 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15887 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15888 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15889 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15890 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15891 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15892 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15893
15894req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15895hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15896 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15897 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15898 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15899 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15900 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15901 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15902 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15903 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15904 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15905
15906req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15907hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15908 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15909 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15910 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15911 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15912 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015913 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15915 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15916
15917req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15918hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15919 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15920 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15921 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15922 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15923 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15924 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15925 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15926
15927http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15928 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15929 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15930 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15931 basic auth is supported.
15932
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015933http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15934 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15935 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15936 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15937 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15939 basic auth is supported.
15940
15941 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015942 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15943 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15944 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15945 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015946
15947http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015948 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15949 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015950 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15951 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953method : integer + string
15954 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15955 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15956 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15957 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15958 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15959 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15960 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015962 ACL derivatives :
15963 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015965 Example :
15966 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15967 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15968 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015970path : string
15971 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15972 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15973 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15974 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15975 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015976 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015977 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979 ACL derivatives :
15980 path : exact string match
15981 path_beg : prefix match
15982 path_dir : subdir match
15983 path_dom : domain match
15984 path_end : suffix match
15985 path_len : length match
15986 path_reg : regex match
15987 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015988
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015989query : string
15990 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15991 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15992 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15993 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015994 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015995 which stops before the question mark.
15996
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015997req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15998 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15999 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16000 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16001 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003req.ver : string
16004req_ver : string (deprecated)
16005 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16006 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16007 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009 ACL derivatives :
16010 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016012res.comp : boolean
16013 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16014 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16015 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017res.comp_algo : string
16018 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16019 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16020 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016022res.cook([<name>]) : string
16023scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16024 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16025 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16026 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016028 ACL derivatives :
16029 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16032scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16033 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16034 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16035 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016037res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16038scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16039 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16040 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16041 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16044 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16045 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16046 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16047 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16048 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16049 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16050 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16051 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16052 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16055 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16056 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16057 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16058 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16059 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016061res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16062shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16063 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16064 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16065 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16066 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16067 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16068 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16069 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16070 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016072 ACL derivatives :
16073 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16074 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16075 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16076 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16077 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16078 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16079 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16080 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16081
16082res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16083shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16084 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16085 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16086 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16087 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16088 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16091shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16092 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16093 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16094 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16095 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16096 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16097 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016098
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016099res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16100 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16101 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16102 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16103 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016105res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16106shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16107 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16108 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16109 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16110 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16111 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16112 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016114res.ver : string
16115resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16116 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16117 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016119 ACL derivatives :
16120 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016122set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16123 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16124 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016125 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016128 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16129 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016131status : integer
16132 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16133 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16134 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016135
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016136unique-id : string
16137 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16138 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16139 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16140 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16141 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16142 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016144url : string
16145 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16146 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16147 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16148 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16149 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16150 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16151 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016153 ACL derivatives :
16154 url : exact string match
16155 url_beg : prefix match
16156 url_dir : subdir match
16157 url_dom : domain match
16158 url_end : suffix match
16159 url_len : length match
16160 url_reg : regex match
16161 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016163url_ip : ip
16164 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16165 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16166 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16167 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16168 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16169 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16170 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016172url_port : integer
16173 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16174 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16175 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16176 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016177
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016178urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16179url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016180 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16181 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016182 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16183 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16184 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16185 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16187 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016188 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16189 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016191 ACL derivatives :
16192 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16193 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16194 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16195 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16196 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16197 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16198 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16199 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016200
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016202 Example :
16203 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16204 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16205 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16206 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016207
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016208urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016209 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16210 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16211 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016212
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016213url32 : integer
16214 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16215 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16216 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16217 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16218 is an unsigned integer.
16219
16220url32+src : binary
16221 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16222 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16223 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16224
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162267.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016227---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016229Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16230every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016231order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016233ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16234---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016235FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016236HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016237HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16238HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016239HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16240HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16241HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16242HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16243LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016244METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016245METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016246METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16247METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16248METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16249METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016250METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016251METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016252RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016253REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016254TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016255WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16256---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016257
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162598. Logging
16260----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016261
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016262One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16263provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16264very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16265provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16266state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016267to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016268headers.
16269
16270In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16271about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16272send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16273
16274 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16275 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16276 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16277 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16278 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016279 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016280 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016281
16282The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16283allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16284as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16285while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16286real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16287delay.
16288
16289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162908.1. Log levels
16291---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016292
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016293TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016294source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016295HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16296in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16297track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16298syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16299about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016300
16301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163028.2. Log formats
16303----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016304
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016305HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016306and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16307slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16308options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016309
16310 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16311 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16312 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16313 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16314 extents.
16315
16316 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16317 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16318 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16319 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16320 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16321
16322 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16323 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16324 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16325 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16326 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16327
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016328 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16329 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16330 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16331 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16332
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016333 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16334
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016335Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16336specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16337field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16338servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16339always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16340identifier.
16341
16342Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16343 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16344 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16345 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16346 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16347
16348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163498.2.1. Default log format
16350-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016351
16352This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16353as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16354format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16355
16356 Example :
16357 listen www
16358 mode http
16359 log global
16360 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16361
16362 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16363 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16364 (www/HTTP)
16365
16366 Field Format Extract from the example above
16367 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16368 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16369 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16370 4 'to' to
16371 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16372 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16373
16374Detailed fields description :
16375 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16376 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16377 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16378 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16379 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16380 and processed the connection.
16381 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16382
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016383In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16384"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16385connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16386
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016387It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16388will eventually disappear.
16389
16390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163918.2.2. TCP log format
16392---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016393
16394The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16395is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16396information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16397counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16398emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16399environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16400the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16401sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016402specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16403not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16404fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16405marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016406
16407 Example :
16408 frontend fnt
16409 mode tcp
16410 option tcplog
16411 log global
16412 default_backend bck
16413
16414 backend bck
16415 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16416
16417 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16418 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16419 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16420
16421 Field Format Extract from the example above
16422 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16423 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16424 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16425 4 frontend_name fnt
16426 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16427 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16428 7 bytes_read* 212
16429 8 termination_state --
16430 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16431 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16432
16433Detailed fields description :
16434 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016435 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16436 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16437 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016438 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016439 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016440 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016441
16442 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016443 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16444 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16445 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016446
16447 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16448 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16449 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016450 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16451 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16452 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16453 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016454
16455 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16456 and processed the connection.
16457
16458 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16459 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16460 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16461 applications.
16462
16463 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16464 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16465 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16466 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16467 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16468
16469 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16470 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16471 See "Timers" below for more details.
16472
16473 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16474 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16475 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16476 "Timers" below for more details.
16477
16478 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016479 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016480 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16481 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16482 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16483 details.
16484
16485 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16486 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16487 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16488 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16489 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16490
16491 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16492 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16493 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16494 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16495 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16496 for more details.
16497
16498 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016499 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016500 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16501 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16502 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016503 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016504
16505 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16506 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16507 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16508 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16509 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16510 caused by a denial of service attack.
16511
16512 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16513 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16514 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16515 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16516 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16517 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16518 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16519 denial of service attack.
16520
16521 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16522 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16523 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16524 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16525 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16526 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16527 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16528 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16529 be processed than on other servers.
16530
16531 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16532 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16533 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16534 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16535 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16536 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16537 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16538 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16539 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16540 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16541 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16542 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16543 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16544
16545 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16546 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16547 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16548 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16549 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16550 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016551 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016552 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16553
16554 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16555 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16556 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16557 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16558 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16559 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016560 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016561 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16562 occurs.
16563
16564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165658.2.3. HTTP log format
16566----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016567
16568The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16569is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16570the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16571are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16572emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16573generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16574"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16575which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016576frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16577is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016578
16579Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16580slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16581with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16582
16583 Example :
16584 frontend http-in
16585 mode http
16586 option httplog
16587 log global
16588 default_backend bck
16589
16590 backend static
16591 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16592
16593 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16594 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16595 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016596 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016597
16598 Field Format Extract from the example above
16599 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16600 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016601 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016602 4 frontend_name http-in
16603 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016604 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016605 7 status_code 200
16606 8 bytes_read* 2750
16607 9 captured_request_cookie -
16608 10 captured_response_cookie -
16609 11 termination_state ----
16610 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16611 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16612 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16613 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16614 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016615
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016616Detailed fields description :
16617 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016618 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16619 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16620 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016621 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016622 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016623 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016624
16625 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016626 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16627 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16628 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016629
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016630 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16631 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016632
16633 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16634 and processed the connection.
16635
16636 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16637 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16638 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16639
16640 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16641 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16642 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16643 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16644 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16645 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16646
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016647 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16648 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16649 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16650 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16651 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16652 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016653 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16654 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016655
16656 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16657 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016658 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016659
16660 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16661 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016662 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16663 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016664
16665 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16666 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16667 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16668 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16669 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016670 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16671 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016672
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016673 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16674 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16675 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16676 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16677 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16678 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16679 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016680 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016681
16682 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16683 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16684 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16685
16686 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16687 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16688 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16689 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16690 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16691 overflowing.
16692
16693 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16694 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16695 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16696 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16697 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16698 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16699 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16700 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16701
16702 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16703 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16704 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16705 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16706 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16707 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16708 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16709 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16710
16711 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16712 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16713 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16714 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16715 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16716 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16717 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16718
16719 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016720 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016721 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16722 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16723 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016724 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016725 system.
16726
16727 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16728 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16729 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16730 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16731 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16732 caused by a denial of service attack.
16733
16734 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16735 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16736 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16737 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16738 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16739 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16740 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16741 denial of service attack.
16742
16743 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16744 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16745 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16746 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16747 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16748 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16749 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16750 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16751 processed than on other servers.
16752
16753 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16754 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16755 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16756 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16757 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16758 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16759 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16760 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16761 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16762 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16763 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16764 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16765 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16766
16767 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16768 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16769 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16770 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16771 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16772 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016773 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016774 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16775
16776 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16777 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16778 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16779 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16780 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16781 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016782 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016783 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16784 occurs.
16785
16786 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16787 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16788 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16789 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16790 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16791 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16792 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16793 cookies" below for more details.
16794
16795 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16796 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16797 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16798 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16799 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16800 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16801 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16802 and cookies" below for more details.
16803
16804 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16805 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16806 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16807 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16808 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16809 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16810 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16811 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16812
16813
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168148.2.4. Custom log format
16815------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016816
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016817The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016818mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016819
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016820HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016821Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16822separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16823prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16824
16825Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16826variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016827("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016828
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016829If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016830as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016831less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16832the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16833
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016834Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016835In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016836in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016837
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016838Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16839'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16840https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16841such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16842
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016843Flags are :
16844 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016845 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016846 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16847 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016848
16849 Example:
16850
16851 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16852 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16853
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016854 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16855
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016856At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16857
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016858 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16859 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016860
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016861the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016862
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016863 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16864 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16865 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016866
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016867and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16868
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016869 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16870 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016871
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016872Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16873
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016874 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016875 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016876 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16877 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16878 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016879 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16880 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16881 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016882 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016883 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16884 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016885 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016886 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16887 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016888 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016889 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016890 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016891 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016892 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016893 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016894 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016895 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16896 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16897 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16898 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16899 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016900 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016901 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16902 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016903 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016904 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16905 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016906 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16907 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16908 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016909 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016910 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16911 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016912 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016913 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16914 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16915 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016916 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016917 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016918 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16919 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16920 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16921 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016922 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016923 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016924 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016925 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016926 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016927 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016928 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16929 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16930 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016931 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016932 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16933 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016934 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016935 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16936 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016937 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016938 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016939 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016940 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016941
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016942 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016943
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016944
169458.2.5. Error log format
16946-----------------------
16947
16948When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16949protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16950By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16951"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016952will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016953logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16954
16955The format looks like this :
16956
16957 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16958 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16959 Connection error during SSL handshake
16960
16961 Field Format Extract from the example above
16962 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16963 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16964 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16965 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16966 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16967
16968These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16969failures.
16970
16971
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169728.3. Advanced logging options
16973-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016974
16975Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16976just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16977options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16978for more information about their usage.
16979
16980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16982------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016983
16984It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16985haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16986commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16987monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16988ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16989
16990 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16991 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16992 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16993 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16994
16995 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16996 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16997 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016998 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016999 such as other load-balancers.
17000
17001 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17002 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17003 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17004
17005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17007----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017008
17009The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17010what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17011or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017012"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017013just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17014log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17015after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17016is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17017with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17018with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17019
17020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170218.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17022------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017023
17024Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17025for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17026"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17027retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17028raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17029a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17030file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17031you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17032"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17033
17034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170358.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17036--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017037
17038Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17039multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17040them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17041"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17042logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17043error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17044and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17045too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17046useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17047alternative.
17048
17049
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170508.4. Timing events
17051------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017052
17053Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17054reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17055the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17056frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017057mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17058addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17059
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017060Timings events in HTTP mode:
17061
17062 first request 2nd request
17063 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17064 t tr t tr ...
17065 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17066 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17067 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17068 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17069 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17070
17071Timings events in TCP mode:
17072
17073 TCP session
17074 |<----------------->|
17075 t t
17076 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17077 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17078 |<------ Tt ------->|
17079
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017080 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017081 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017082 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17083 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17084 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017085 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017086 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17087 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17088 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17089 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017090
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017091 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17092 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17093 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017094 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17095 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17096 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17097 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17098 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17099 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017100
17101 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17102 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17103 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17104 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17105 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17106 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17107 request typed by hand during a test.
17108
17109 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17110 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017111 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017112 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17113 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17114 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17115 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017116
17117 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17118 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17119 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17120 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17121 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17122
17123 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17124 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17125 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17126 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17127 connection never established.
17128
17129 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17130 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17131 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17132 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17133 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17134 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17135 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17136 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17137 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17138 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17139 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17140
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017141 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17142 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17143 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17144 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17145 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17146 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17147
17148 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17149
17150 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17151 "Ta" can never be negative.
17152
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017153 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17154 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017155 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17156 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017157 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017158
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017159 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017160
17161 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017162 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17163 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017164
17165These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17166protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17167that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017168due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17169"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17170that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017171
17172Most common cases :
17173
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017174 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17175 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17176 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17177 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17178 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17179 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17180 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17181 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17182 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17183 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17184 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017185 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017186
17187 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17188 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17189 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17190 of ms on remote networks.
17191
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017192 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17193 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17194 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017195
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017196 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17197 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17198 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17199 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17200 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17201 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17202 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17203 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17204 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017205
17206Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17207
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017208 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017209 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017210 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017211
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017212 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017213 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17214 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17215
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017216 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017217 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17218 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17219 flags.
17220
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017221 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17222 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017223 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17224 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17225 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17226 the client connection was maintained open.
17227
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017228 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017229 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017230 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017231 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17232
17233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172348.5. Session state at disconnection
17235-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017236
17237TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17238"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
172392-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17240each of which has a special meaning :
17241
17242 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17243 session to terminate :
17244
17245 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17246
17247 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17248 server explicitly refused it.
17249
17250 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17251 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17252 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17253 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017254 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017255
17256 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17257 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017258
17259 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17260 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17261 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17262 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17263 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17264
17265 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17266 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17267 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17268 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17269 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17270
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017271 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17272 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17273
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017274 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17275 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17276 backup connections when going up.
17277
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017278 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17279
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017280 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17281 send or receive data.
17282
17283 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17284 send or receive data.
17285
17286 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17287 with nothing left in the buffers.
17288
17289 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17290
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017291 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017292 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17293
17294 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17295 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17296 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17297 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17298 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17299
17300 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17301 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17302
17303 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17304 server (HTTP only).
17305
17306 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17307
17308 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17309 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17310 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17311
17312 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17313 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17314 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17315
17316 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17317
17318 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17319 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17320
17321 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17322 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17323 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17324
17325 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17326 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017327 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17328 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017329
17330 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17331 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17332 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17333 another server.
17334
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017335 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017336 server.
17337
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017338 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17339 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17340 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17341 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17342
17343 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17344 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17345 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17346 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17347
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017348 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17349 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17350 "use-server" rule).
17351
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017352 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17353
17354 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17355 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17356
17357 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17358
17359 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17360 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17361 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17362
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017363 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17364 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017365 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017366 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17367 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17368
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017369 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17370
17371 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17372 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17373
17374 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17375
17376 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17377
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017378The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17379was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017380helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17381starvation, attacks, etc...
17382
17383The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17384alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17385easier finding and understanding.
17386
17387 Flags Reason
17388
17389 -- Normal termination.
17390
17391 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17392 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17393 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17394 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17395
17396 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17397 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17398 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17399 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17400 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17401 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017402
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017403 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17404 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017405 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017406
17407 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17408 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17409 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17410
17411 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17412 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17413 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17414 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17415 the server takes too long to respond.
17416
17417 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17418 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17419 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17420 long a time to respond.
17421
17422 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17423 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17424 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17425 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017426 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17427 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017428
17429 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17430 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17431 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17432 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17433 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017434 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017435 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17436 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17437 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17438 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17439 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17440 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17441 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17442 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017443 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017444 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17445 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17446 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017447
17448 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17449 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017450 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17451 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17452 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17453 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017454
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017455 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17456 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017458 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017459 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17460 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017461 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017462 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17463 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17464
17465 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17466 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17467 503 or 504 here.
17468
17469 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17470 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17471 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17472 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17473 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17474
17475 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17476 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017477 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017478 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17479 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17480
17481 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17482 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17483 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17484 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17485 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17486 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17487 between haproxy and the server.
17488
17489 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17490 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17491 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17492 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17493 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17494 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17495 solution is to fix the application.
17496
17497 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17498 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17499 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17500 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17501 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17502 external attacks.
17503
17504 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17505 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017506 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017507 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17508 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17509
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017510 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17511 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17512 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017513 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017514 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017515
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017516 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17517 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17518 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17519 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017520 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17521 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17522 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17523 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17524 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017525
17526 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17527 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17528 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17529 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17530
17531 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17532 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17533 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17534 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17535
17536 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17537 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17538 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17539 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17540
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017541The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17542persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17543important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17544re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17545
17546 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17547
17548 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17549 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17550 set on a GET request.
17551
17552 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17553 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017554 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017555 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17556
17557 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17558 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17559 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17560
17561 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17562 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17563 already got a cookie.
17564
17565 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17566 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17567 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17568 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17569 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17570
17571 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17572 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17573 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17574
17575 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17576 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17577 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17578
17579 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17580 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17581
17582 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17583 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17584 then advertised in the response.
17585
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175878.6. Non-printable characters
17588-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017589
17590In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17591consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17592converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17593prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17594being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17595escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17596is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17597'}' when logging headers.
17598
17599Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17600issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17601containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17602
17603Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17604the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17605performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17606
17607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176088.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17609---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017610
17611Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17612achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017613section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017614cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17615the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17616the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017617locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017618not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17619user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17620a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17621wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17622
17623 Examples :
17624 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17625 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17626
17627 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17628 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17629
17630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176318.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17632---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017633
17634Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17635proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17636the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17637server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17638
17639Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17640response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017641section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017642
17643It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017644time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17645appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017646are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17647and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17648follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17649request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17650in the logs.
17651
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017652As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17653frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17654an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17655
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017656 Example :
17657 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17658 listen proxy-out
17659 mode http
17660 option httplog
17661 option logasap
17662 log global
17663 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17664
17665 # log the name of the virtual server
17666 capture request header Host len 20
17667
17668 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17669 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17670
17671 # log the beginning of the referrer
17672 capture request header Referer len 20
17673
17674 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17675 capture response header Server len 20
17676
17677 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17678 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17679
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017680 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017681 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17682
17683 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17684 capture response header Via len 20
17685
17686 # log the URL location during a redirection
17687 capture response header Location len 20
17688
17689 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17690 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17691 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17692 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17693 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17694
17695 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17696 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17697 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17698 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017699 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017700
17701 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17702 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17703 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17704 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17705 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017706 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017707
17708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177098.9. Examples of logs
17710---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017711
17712These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17713them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17714reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17715
17716 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17717 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17718 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17719
17720 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17721 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17722
17723 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17724 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17725 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17726
17727 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17728 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17729
17730 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17731 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17732 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17733
17734 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017735 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017736 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17737 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17738
17739 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17740 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17741 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17742
17743 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17744 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017745 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017746 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17747 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17748 to return the 502 and not the server.
17749
17750 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017751 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017752
17753 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17754 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17755 Nothing was sent to any server.
17756
17757 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17758 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17759
17760 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17761 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017762 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017763 send a 408 return code to the client.
17764
17765 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17766 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17767
17768 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17769 5 seconds ("c----").
17770
17771 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17772 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017773 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017774
17775 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017776 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017777 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17778 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17779 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17780 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17781 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017782
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017783
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200177849. Supported filters
17785--------------------
17786
17787Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17788accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17789unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17790
17791See also : "filter"
17792
177939.1. Trace
17794----------
17795
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017796filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017797
17798 Arguments:
17799 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17800 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17801
17802 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17803 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17804 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17805 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17806
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017807 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017808 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17809 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17810 amount of the parsed data.
17811
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017812 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017813
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017814This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17815callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17816information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17817filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17818
17819Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17820tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17821a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17822
17823
178249.2. HTTP compression
17825---------------------
17826
17827filter compression
17828
17829The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17830keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017831when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17832it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17833response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17834line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17835cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17836the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017837
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017838See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017839
17840
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200178419.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17842--------------------------------------------
17843
17844filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17845
17846 Arguments :
17847
17848 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17849 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17850 parsed.
17851
17852 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17853 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17854 part must be placed in its own scope.
17855
17856The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17857external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017858streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017859exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17860also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17861
17862SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17863the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17864
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017865For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017866"doc/SPOE.txt".
17867
17868Important note:
17869 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17870 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17871
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100178729.4. Cache
17873----------
17874
17875filter cache <name>
17876
17877 Arguments :
17878
17879 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17880
17881The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17882"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17883cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017884other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17885the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17886mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17887filter other than the compression is used for the same
17888listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17889order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017890
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017891See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017892
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001789310. Cache
17894---------
17895
17896HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17897(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17898RAM.
17899
17900The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017901this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017902
17903If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17904independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17905when we try to allocate a new one.
17906
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017907The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017908
17909It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17910"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17911for more details.
17912
17913When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17914replaced by "<CACHE>".
17915
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001791610.1. Limitation
17917----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017918
17919The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17920
17921- If the response is not a 200
17922- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017923- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017924- If the response is not cacheable
17925
17926- If the request is not a GET
17927- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017928- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017929
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017930Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
17931filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
17932can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
17933example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
17934"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017935
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001793610.2. Setup
17937-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017938
17939To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17940the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17941
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001794210.2.1. Cache section
17943---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017944
17945cache <name>
17946 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17947 size of cache is mandatory.
17948
17949total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017950 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017951 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017952
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017953max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017954 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17955 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17956 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017957
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017958max-age <seconds>
17959 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17960 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17961 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17962 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17963 default.
17964
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001796510.2.2. Proxy section
17966---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017967
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020017968http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017969 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17970 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17971 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17972 after this one.
17973
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020017974http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017975 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17976 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17977 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17978 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17979
17980
17981Example:
17982
17983 backend bck1
17984 mode http
17985
17986 http-request cache-use foobar
17987 http-response cache-store foobar
17988 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17989
17990 cache foobar
17991 total-max-size 4
17992 max-age 240
17993
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017994/*
17995 * Local variables:
17996 * fill-column: 79
17997 * End:
17998 */